1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H
3 #define __NET_CFG80211_H
4 /*
5 * 802.11 device and configuration interface
6 *
7 * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <[email protected]>
8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9 * Copyright 2015-2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10 * Copyright (C) 2018-2024 Intel Corporation
11 */
12
13 #include <linux/ethtool.h>
14 #include <uapi/linux/rfkill.h>
15 #include <linux/netdevice.h>
16 #include <linux/debugfs.h>
17 #include <linux/list.h>
18 #include <linux/bug.h>
19 #include <linux/netlink.h>
20 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
21 #include <linux/nl80211.h>
22 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
23 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
24 #include <linux/net.h>
25 #include <linux/rfkill.h>
26 #include <net/regulatory.h>
27
28 /**
29 * DOC: Introduction
30 *
31 * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges
32 * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated
33 * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used
34 * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent
35 * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers
36 * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely.
37 *
38 * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum
39 * use restrictions.
40 */
41
42
43 /**
44 * DOC: Device registration
45 *
46 * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device
47 * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs
48 * described below.
49 *
50 * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each
51 * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each
52 * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with
53 * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's
54 * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes
55 * the wireless part of the interface. Normally this struct is embedded in the
56 * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating
57 * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the
58 * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful.
59 *
60 * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has
61 * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and
62 * structures here describe these capabilities in detail.
63 */
64
65 struct wiphy;
66
67 /*
68 * wireless hardware capability structures
69 */
70
71 /**
72 * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags
73 *
74 * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code.
75 *
76 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled.
77 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes
78 * sending probe requests or beaconing.
79 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD: Power spectral density (in dBm) is set for this
80 * channel.
81 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel.
82 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel
83 * is not permitted.
84 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel
85 * is not permitted.
86 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel.
87 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band,
88 * this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this
89 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
90 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
91 * restrictions.
92 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band,
93 * this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this
94 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
95 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
96 * restrictions.
97 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY
98 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
99 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
100 * on this channel.
101 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
102 * on this channel.
103 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel.
104 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted
105 * on this channel.
106 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted
107 * on this channel.
108 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted
109 * on this channel.
110 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted
111 * on this channel.
112 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted
113 * on this channel.
114 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ: If the driver supports 320 MHz on the band,
115 * this flag indicates that a 320 MHz channel cannot use this
116 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
117 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
118 * restrictions.
119 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not permitted on this channel.
120 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DFS_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_RRF_DFS_CONCURRENT
121 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT: Client connection with VLP AP
122 * not permitted using this channel
123 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT: Client connection with AFC AP
124 * not permitted using this channel
125 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_CAN_MONITOR: This channel can be used for monitor
126 * mode even in the presence of other (regulatory) restrictions,
127 * even if it is otherwise disabled.
128 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP: Allow using this channel for AP operation
129 * with very low power (VLP), even if otherwise set to NO_IR.
130 */
131 enum ieee80211_channel_flags {
132 IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED = BIT(0),
133 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR = BIT(1),
134 IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD = BIT(2),
135 IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR = BIT(3),
136 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS = BIT(4),
137 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS = BIT(5),
138 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM = BIT(6),
139 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ = BIT(7),
140 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ = BIT(8),
141 IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY = BIT(9),
142 IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT = BIT(10),
143 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ = BIT(11),
144 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ = BIT(12),
145 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE = BIT(13),
146 IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ = BIT(14),
147 IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ = BIT(15),
148 IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ = BIT(16),
149 IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ = BIT(17),
150 IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ = BIT(18),
151 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ = BIT(19),
152 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT = BIT(20),
153 IEEE80211_CHAN_DFS_CONCURRENT = BIT(21),
154 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT = BIT(22),
155 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT = BIT(23),
156 IEEE80211_CHAN_CAN_MONITOR = BIT(24),
157 IEEE80211_CHAN_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP = BIT(25),
158 };
159
160 #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \
161 (IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS)
162
163 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS 60000
164 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS (30 * 60 * 1000)
165
166 /**
167 * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition
168 *
169 * This structure describes a single channel for use
170 * with cfg80211.
171 *
172 * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz
173 * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz
174 * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel
175 * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags.
176 * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory
177 * code to support devices with additional restrictions
178 * @band: band this channel belongs to.
179 * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi
180 * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm)
181 * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm)
182 * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon
183 * has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon()
184 * to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band.
185 * @orig_mag: internal use
186 * @orig_mpwr: internal use
187 * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required
188 * on this channel.
189 * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
190 * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels.
191 * @psd: power spectral density (in dBm)
192 */
193 struct ieee80211_channel {
194 enum nl80211_band band;
195 u32 center_freq;
196 u16 freq_offset;
197 u16 hw_value;
198 u32 flags;
199 int max_antenna_gain;
200 int max_power;
201 int max_reg_power;
202 bool beacon_found;
203 u32 orig_flags;
204 int orig_mag, orig_mpwr;
205 enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state;
206 unsigned long dfs_state_entered;
207 unsigned int dfs_cac_ms;
208 s8 psd;
209 };
210
211 /**
212 * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags
213 *
214 * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured
215 * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for
216 * different bands/PHY modes.
217 *
218 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short
219 * preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and
220 * with CCK rates.
221 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
222 * when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the
223 * core code when registering the wiphy.
224 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
225 * when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
226 * core code when registering the wiphy.
227 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
228 * when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
229 * core code when registering the wiphy.
230 * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode.
231 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode
232 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode
233 */
234 enum ieee80211_rate_flags {
235 IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = BIT(0),
236 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A = BIT(1),
237 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B = BIT(2),
238 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G = BIT(3),
239 IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G = BIT(4),
240 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ = BIT(5),
241 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ = BIT(6),
242 };
243
244 /**
245 * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter
246 *
247 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS
248 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS
249 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS
250 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS
251 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type
252 */
253 enum ieee80211_bss_type {
254 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS,
255 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS,
256 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
257 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS,
258 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY
259 };
260
261 /**
262 * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter
263 *
264 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set
265 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear
266 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting
267 */
268 enum ieee80211_privacy {
269 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON,
270 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF,
271 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY
272 };
273
274 #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x) \
275 ((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF)
276
277 /**
278 * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition
279 *
280 * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can
281 * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short
282 * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are
283 * passed around.
284 *
285 * @flags: rate-specific flags from &enum ieee80211_rate_flags
286 * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps
287 * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate
288 * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when
289 * short preamble is used
290 */
291 struct ieee80211_rate {
292 u32 flags;
293 u16 bitrate;
294 u16 hw_value, hw_value_short;
295 };
296
297 /**
298 * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse
299 *
300 * @enable: is the feature enabled.
301 * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element.
302 * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset
303 * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use
304 * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use
305 * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by
306 * members of the SRG
307 * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values
308 * used by members of the SRG
309 */
310 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd {
311 bool enable;
312 u8 sr_ctrl;
313 u8 non_srg_max_offset;
314 u8 min_offset;
315 u8 max_offset;
316 u8 bss_color_bitmap[8];
317 u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8];
318 };
319
320 /**
321 * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring
322 *
323 * @color: the current color.
324 * @enabled: HE BSS color is used
325 * @partial: define the AID equation.
326 */
327 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color {
328 u8 color;
329 bool enabled;
330 bool partial;
331 };
332
333 /**
334 * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities
335 *
336 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
337 * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA.
338 *
339 * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA
340 * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec
341 * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor
342 * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing
343 * @mcs: Supported MCS rates
344 */
345 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap {
346 u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */
347 bool ht_supported;
348 u8 ampdu_factor;
349 u8 ampdu_density;
350 struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs;
351 };
352
353 /**
354 * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities
355 *
356 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
357 * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA.
358 *
359 * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA
360 * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec
361 * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates
362 */
363 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap {
364 bool vht_supported;
365 u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */
366 struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs;
367 };
368
369 #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN 25
370
371 /**
372 * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities
373 *
374 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
375 * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA.
376 *
377 * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid.
378 * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element.
379 * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
380 * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
381 */
382 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap {
383 bool has_he;
384 struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem;
385 struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp;
386 u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
387 };
388
389 /**
390 * struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp - EHT max supported NSS per MCS
391 *
392 * See P802.11be_D1.3 Table 9-401k - "Subfields of the Supported EHT-MCS
393 * and NSS Set field"
394 *
395 * @only_20mhz: MCS/NSS support for 20 MHz-only STA.
396 * @bw: MCS/NSS support for 80, 160 and 320 MHz
397 * @bw._80: MCS/NSS support for BW <= 80 MHz
398 * @bw._160: MCS/NSS support for BW = 160 MHz
399 * @bw._320: MCS/NSS support for BW = 320 MHz
400 */
401 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp {
402 union {
403 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_20mhz_only only_20mhz;
404 struct {
405 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _80;
406 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _160;
407 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _320;
408 } __packed bw;
409 } __packed;
410 } __packed;
411
412 #define IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN 32
413
414 /**
415 * struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap - STA's EHT capabilities
416 *
417 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
418 * to describe 802.11be EHT capabilities for a STA.
419 *
420 * @has_eht: true iff EHT data is valid.
421 * @eht_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the eht capabilities element.
422 * @eht_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
423 * @eht_ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
424 */
425 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap {
426 bool has_eht;
427 struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem_fixed eht_cap_elem;
428 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp eht_mcs_nss_supp;
429 u8 eht_ppe_thres[IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
430 };
431
432 /* sparse defines __CHECKER__; see Documentation/dev-tools/sparse.rst */
433 #ifdef __CHECKER__
434 /*
435 * This is used to mark the sband->iftype_data pointer which is supposed
436 * to be an array with special access semantics (per iftype), but a lot
437 * of code got it wrong in the past, so with this marking sparse will be
438 * noisy when the pointer is used directly.
439 */
440 # define __iftd __attribute__((noderef, address_space(__iftype_data)))
441 #else
442 # define __iftd
443 #endif /* __CHECKER__ */
444
445 /**
446 * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data - sband data per interface type
447 *
448 * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the
449 * interface types defined in @types_mask. Each type in the
450 * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data.
451 *
452 * @types_mask: interface types mask
453 * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities
454 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a
455 * 6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value).
456 * @eht_cap: STA's EHT capabilities
457 * @vendor_elems: vendor element(s) to advertise
458 * @vendor_elems.data: vendor element(s) data
459 * @vendor_elems.len: vendor element(s) length
460 */
461 struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data {
462 u16 types_mask;
463 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
464 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
465 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
466 struct {
467 const u8 *data;
468 unsigned int len;
469 } vendor_elems;
470 };
471
472 /**
473 * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations
474 *
475 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz
476 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz
477 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz
478 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz
479 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
480 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
481 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz
482 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and
483 * 2.16GHz+2.16GHz
484 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
485 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
486 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
487 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
488 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
489 * and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
490 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz,
491 * 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
492 */
493 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config {
494 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4 = 4,
495 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5 = 5,
496 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6 = 6,
497 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7 = 7,
498 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8 = 8,
499 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9 = 9,
500 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10 = 10,
501 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11 = 11,
502 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12 = 12,
503 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13 = 13,
504 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14 = 14,
505 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15 = 15,
506 };
507
508 /**
509 * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration
510 *
511 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
512 * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration
513 *
514 * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s)
515 * that are allowed to be used for transmissions.
516 * Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc.
517 * Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported.
518 * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
519 * the allowed channel bandwidth configurations
520 */
521 struct ieee80211_edmg {
522 u8 channels;
523 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config;
524 };
525
526 /**
527 * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities
528 *
529 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
530 * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA.
531 *
532 * @s1g: is STA an S1G STA
533 * @cap: S1G capabilities information
534 * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set
535 */
536 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap {
537 bool s1g;
538 u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */
539 u8 nss_mcs[5];
540 };
541
542 /**
543 * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition
544 *
545 * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy
546 * is able to operate in.
547 *
548 * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with
549 * in this band.
550 * @band: the band this structure represents
551 * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels
552 * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with
553 * in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported
554 * rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM.
555 * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates
556 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band
557 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band
558 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band
559 * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band
560 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course)
561 * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries
562 * @iftype_data: interface type data entries. Note that the bits in
563 * @types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only
564 * one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of
565 * iftype_data).
566 */
567 struct ieee80211_supported_band {
568 struct ieee80211_channel *channels;
569 struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates;
570 enum nl80211_band band;
571 int n_channels;
572 int n_bitrates;
573 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
574 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
575 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap;
576 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap;
577 u16 n_iftype_data;
578 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data __iftd *iftype_data;
579 };
580
581 /**
582 * _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array
583 * @sband: the sband to initialize
584 * @iftd: the iftype data array pointer
585 * @n_iftd: the length of the iftype data array
586 *
587 * Set the sband iftype data array; use this where the length cannot
588 * be derived from the ARRAY_SIZE() of the argument, but prefer
589 * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data() where it can be used.
590 */
591 static inline void
_ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data * iftd,u16 n_iftd)592 _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
593 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftd,
594 u16 n_iftd)
595 {
596 sband->iftype_data = (const void __iftd __force *)iftd;
597 sband->n_iftype_data = n_iftd;
598 }
599
600 /**
601 * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array
602 * @sband: the sband to initialize
603 * @iftd: the iftype data array
604 */
605 #define ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd) \
606 _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd, ARRAY_SIZE(iftd))
607
608 /**
609 * for_each_sband_iftype_data - iterate sband iftype data entries
610 * @sband: the sband whose iftype_data array to iterate
611 * @i: iterator counter
612 * @iftd: iftype data pointer to set
613 */
614 #define for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, iftd) \
615 for (i = 0, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i]; \
616 i < (sband)->n_iftype_data; \
617 i++, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i])
618
619 /**
620 * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype
621 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
622 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
623 *
624 * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found
625 */
626 static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *
ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,u8 iftype)627 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
628 u8 iftype)
629 {
630 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data;
631 int i;
632
633 if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX))
634 return NULL;
635
636 if (iftype == NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN)
637 iftype = NL80211_IFTYPE_AP;
638
639 for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, data) {
640 if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype))
641 return data;
642 }
643
644 return NULL;
645 }
646
647 /**
648 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype
649 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
650 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
651 *
652 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found
653 */
654 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,u8 iftype)655 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
656 u8 iftype)
657 {
658 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
659 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
660
661 if (data && data->he_cap.has_he)
662 return &data->he_cap;
663
664 return NULL;
665 }
666
667 /**
668 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
669 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
670 * @iftype: the iftype to search for
671 *
672 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
673 */
674 static inline __le16
ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)675 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
676 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
677 {
678 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
679 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
680
681 if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he))
682 return 0;
683
684 return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa;
685 }
686
687 /**
688 * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap - return ETH capabilities for an sband's iftype
689 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
690 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
691 *
692 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or NULL is none found
693 */
694 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)695 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
696 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
697 {
698 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
699 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
700
701 if (data && data->eht_cap.has_eht)
702 return &data->eht_cap;
703
704 return NULL;
705 }
706
707 /**
708 * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree
709 *
710 * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for
711 *
712 * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful
713 * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board
714 * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier).
715 *
716 * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable
717 * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with
718 * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make
719 * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified
720 * without affecting other devices.
721 *
722 * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev.
723 * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first.
724 * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register().
725 */
726 #ifdef CONFIG_OF
727 void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy);
728 #else /* CONFIG_OF */
wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy * wiphy)729 static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy)
730 {
731 }
732 #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */
733
734
735 /*
736 * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods
737 */
738
739 /**
740 * DOC: Actions and configuration
741 *
742 * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration
743 * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these
744 * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these
745 * operations use are described separately.
746 *
747 * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status
748 * information via some functions that drivers need to call.
749 *
750 * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described
751 * in a separate chapter.
752 */
753
754 #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\
755 WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN)
756
757 /**
758 * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters
759 * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise
760 * %MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set
761 * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames
762 * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface.
763 * If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may
764 * determine the address as needed.
765 * This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the
766 * %NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag. Others may support creating
767 ** only p2p devices with specified MAC.
768 * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets
769 * belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed
770 * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring
771 * MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed
772 */
773 struct vif_params {
774 u32 flags;
775 int use_4addr;
776 u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN];
777 const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups;
778 const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr;
779 };
780
781 /**
782 * struct key_params - key information
783 *
784 * Information about a key
785 *
786 * @key: key material
787 * @key_len: length of key material
788 * @cipher: cipher suite selector
789 * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used
790 * with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian,
791 * length given by @seq_len.
792 * @seq_len: length of @seq.
793 * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero)
794 * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX)
795 */
796 struct key_params {
797 const u8 *key;
798 const u8 *seq;
799 int key_len;
800 int seq_len;
801 u16 vlan_id;
802 u32 cipher;
803 enum nl80211_key_mode mode;
804 };
805
806 /**
807 * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition
808 * @chan: the (control) channel
809 * @width: channel width
810 * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment
811 * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment
812 * (only with 80+80 MHz)
813 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration.
814 * If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero),
815 * chan will define the primary channel and all other
816 * parameters are ignored.
817 * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz
818 * @punctured: mask of the punctured 20 MHz subchannels, with
819 * bits turned on being disabled (punctured); numbered
820 * from lower to higher frequency (like in the spec)
821 */
822 struct cfg80211_chan_def {
823 struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
824 enum nl80211_chan_width width;
825 u32 center_freq1;
826 u32 center_freq2;
827 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
828 u16 freq1_offset;
829 u16 punctured;
830 };
831
832 /*
833 * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control
834 */
835 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask {
836 struct {
837 u32 legacy;
838 u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN];
839 u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
840 u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
841 enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi;
842 enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi;
843 enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf;
844 } control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
845 };
846
847
848 /**
849 * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration
850 * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration
851 * of the peer.
852 * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify
853 * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed,
854 * similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp.
855 * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID
856 * @retry_long: retry count value
857 * @retry_short: retry count value
858 * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
859 * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS
860 * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
861 * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type
862 * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID
863 */
864 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg {
865 bool config_override;
866 u8 tids;
867 u64 mask;
868 enum nl80211_tid_config noack;
869 u8 retry_long, retry_short;
870 enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu;
871 enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts;
872 enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu;
873 enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type;
874 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask;
875 };
876
877 /**
878 * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration
879 * @peer: Station's MAC address
880 * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied
881 * @tid_conf: Configuration change info
882 */
883 struct cfg80211_tid_config {
884 const u8 *peer;
885 u32 n_tid_conf;
886 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[] __counted_by(n_tid_conf);
887 };
888
889 /**
890 * struct cfg80211_fils_aad - FILS AAD data
891 * @macaddr: STA MAC address
892 * @kek: FILS KEK
893 * @kek_len: FILS KEK length
894 * @snonce: STA Nonce
895 * @anonce: AP Nonce
896 */
897 struct cfg80211_fils_aad {
898 const u8 *macaddr;
899 const u8 *kek;
900 u8 kek_len;
901 const u8 *snonce;
902 const u8 *anonce;
903 };
904
905 /**
906 * struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp - enable/disable HW timestamping
907 * @macaddr: peer MAC address. NULL to enable/disable HW timestamping for all
908 * addresses.
909 * @enable: if set, enable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address.
910 * Otherwise disable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address.
911 */
912 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp {
913 const u8 *macaddr;
914 bool enable;
915 };
916
917 /**
918 * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef
919 * @chandef: the channel definition
920 *
921 * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given
922 * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion.
923 */
924 static inline enum nl80211_channel_type
cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)925 cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
926 {
927 switch (chandef->width) {
928 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
929 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
930 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
931 return NL80211_CHAN_HT20;
932 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
933 if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq)
934 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS;
935 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS;
936 default:
937 WARN_ON(1);
938 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
939 }
940 }
941
942 /**
943 * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type
944 * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill
945 * @channel: the control channel
946 * @chantype: the channel type
947 *
948 * Given a channel type, create a channel definition.
949 */
950 void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
951 struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
952 enum nl80211_channel_type chantype);
953
954 /**
955 * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical
956 * @chandef1: first channel definition
957 * @chandef2: second channel definition
958 *
959 * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are
960 * identical, %false otherwise.
961 */
962 static inline bool
cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef1,const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef2)963 cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
964 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2)
965 {
966 return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan &&
967 chandef1->width == chandef2->width &&
968 chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 &&
969 chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset &&
970 chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2 &&
971 chandef1->punctured == chandef2->punctured);
972 }
973
974 /**
975 * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel
976 *
977 * @chandef: the channel definition
978 *
979 * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise.
980 */
981 static inline bool
cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)982 cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
983 {
984 return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config;
985 }
986
987 /**
988 * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible
989 * @chandef1: first channel definition
990 * @chandef2: second channel definition
991 *
992 * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible,
993 * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise.
994 */
995 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *
996 cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
997 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2);
998
999 /**
1000 * nl80211_chan_width_to_mhz - get the channel width in MHz
1001 * @chan_width: the channel width from &enum nl80211_chan_width
1002 *
1003 * Return: channel width in MHz if the chan_width from &enum nl80211_chan_width
1004 * is valid. -1 otherwise.
1005 */
1006 int nl80211_chan_width_to_mhz(enum nl80211_chan_width chan_width);
1007
1008 /**
1009 * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid
1010 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1011 * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise.
1012 */
1013 bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1014
1015 /**
1016 * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used
1017 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1018 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1019 * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set
1020 * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise.
1021 */
1022 bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1023 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
1024 u32 prohibited_flags);
1025
1026 /**
1027 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required
1028 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1029 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1030 * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype
1031 * Returns:
1032 * 1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error
1033 */
1034 int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1035 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
1036 enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
1037
1038 /**
1039 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable - checks if chandef is DFS usable and we
1040 * can/need start CAC on such channel
1041 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1042 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1043 *
1044 * Return: true if all channels available and at least
1045 * one channel requires CAC (NL80211_DFS_USABLE)
1046 */
1047 bool cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1048 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1049
1050 /**
1051 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time - get the DFS CAC time (in ms) for given
1052 * channel definition
1053 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1054 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1055 *
1056 * Returns: DFS CAC time (in ms) which applies for this channel definition
1057 */
1058 unsigned int
1059 cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1060 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1061
1062 /**
1063 * cfg80211_chandef_primary - calculate primary 40/80/160 MHz freq
1064 * @chandef: chandef to calculate for
1065 * @primary_chan_width: primary channel width to calculate center for
1066 * @punctured: punctured sub-channel bitmap, will be recalculated
1067 * according to the new bandwidth, can be %NULL
1068 *
1069 * Returns: the primary 40/80/160 MHz channel center frequency, or -1
1070 * for errors, updating the punctured bitmap
1071 */
1072 int cfg80211_chandef_primary(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
1073 enum nl80211_chan_width primary_chan_width,
1074 u16 *punctured);
1075
1076 /**
1077 * nl80211_send_chandef - sends the channel definition.
1078 * @msg: the msg to send channel definition
1079 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1080 *
1081 * Returns: 0 if sent the channel definition to msg, < 0 on error
1082 **/
1083 int nl80211_send_chandef(struct sk_buff *msg, const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1084
1085 /**
1086 * ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags - return rate flags for channel width
1087 * @width: the channel width of the channel
1088 *
1089 * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK
1090 * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels.
1091 *
1092 * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel width
1093 */
1094 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(enum nl80211_chan_width width)1095 ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(enum nl80211_chan_width width)
1096 {
1097 switch (width) {
1098 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
1099 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ;
1100 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
1101 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ;
1102 default:
1103 break;
1104 }
1105 return 0;
1106 }
1107
1108 /**
1109 * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel
1110 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
1111 *
1112 * See ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags().
1113 *
1114 * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel
1115 */
1116 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)1117 ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
1118 {
1119 return ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(chandef->width);
1120 }
1121
1122 /**
1123 * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef
1124 *
1125 * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel
1126 * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual
1127 * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels.
1128 *
1129 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
1130 *
1131 * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef
1132 */
1133 static inline int
ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)1134 ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
1135 {
1136 switch (chandef->width) {
1137 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
1138 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6,
1139 chandef->chan->max_power);
1140 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
1141 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3,
1142 chandef->chan->max_power);
1143 default:
1144 break;
1145 }
1146 return chandef->chan->max_power;
1147 }
1148
1149 /**
1150 * cfg80211_any_usable_channels - check for usable channels
1151 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check for
1152 * @band_mask: which bands to check on
1153 * @prohibited_flags: which channels to not consider usable,
1154 * %IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED is always taken into account
1155 *
1156 * Return: %true if usable channels found, %false otherwise
1157 */
1158 bool cfg80211_any_usable_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1159 unsigned long band_mask,
1160 u32 prohibited_flags);
1161
1162 /**
1163 * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags
1164 *
1165 * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in
1166 * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
1167 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in
1168 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in
1169 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in
1170 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in
1171 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in
1172 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in
1173 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in
1174 *
1175 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info
1176 * it has filled in during the get_survey().
1177 */
1178 enum survey_info_flags {
1179 SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM = BIT(0),
1180 SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE = BIT(1),
1181 SURVEY_INFO_TIME = BIT(2),
1182 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY = BIT(3),
1183 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY = BIT(4),
1184 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX = BIT(5),
1185 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX = BIT(6),
1186 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN = BIT(7),
1187 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX = BIT(8),
1188 };
1189
1190 /**
1191 * struct survey_info - channel survey response
1192 *
1193 * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single
1194 * record to report global statistics
1195 * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags
1196 * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are
1197 * optional
1198 * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel)
1199 * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy
1200 * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy
1201 * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data
1202 * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data
1203 * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning
1204 * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS
1205 *
1206 * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information.
1207 *
1208 * This structure can later be expanded with things like
1209 * channel duty cycle etc.
1210 */
1211 struct survey_info {
1212 struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
1213 u64 time;
1214 u64 time_busy;
1215 u64 time_ext_busy;
1216 u64 time_rx;
1217 u64 time_tx;
1218 u64 time_scan;
1219 u64 time_bss_rx;
1220 u32 filled;
1221 s8 noise;
1222 };
1223
1224 #define CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES 10
1225
1226 /**
1227 * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings
1228 * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled
1229 * (from enum nl80211_wpa_versions)
1230 * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset)
1231 * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers
1232 * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites
1233 * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites
1234 * @akm_suites: AKM suites
1235 * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
1236 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
1237 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
1238 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
1239 * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be
1240 * allowed through even on unauthorized ports
1241 * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port
1242 * protocol frames.
1243 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
1244 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
1245 * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control
1246 * port for mac80211
1247 * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload)
1248 * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE
1249 * offload)
1250 * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload)
1251 * @sae_pwe: The mechanisms allowed for SAE PWE derivation:
1252 *
1253 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED
1254 * Not-specified, used to indicate userspace did not specify any
1255 * preference. The driver should follow its internal policy in
1256 * such a scenario.
1257 *
1258 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK
1259 * Allow hunting-and-pecking loop only
1260 *
1261 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT
1262 * Allow hash-to-element only
1263 *
1264 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH
1265 * Allow either hunting-and-pecking loop or hash-to-element
1266 */
1267 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings {
1268 u32 wpa_versions;
1269 u32 cipher_group;
1270 int n_ciphers_pairwise;
1271 u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES];
1272 int n_akm_suites;
1273 u32 akm_suites[CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES];
1274 bool control_port;
1275 __be16 control_port_ethertype;
1276 bool control_port_no_encrypt;
1277 bool control_port_over_nl80211;
1278 bool control_port_no_preauth;
1279 const u8 *psk;
1280 const u8 *sae_pwd;
1281 u8 sae_pwd_len;
1282 enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism sae_pwe;
1283 };
1284
1285 /**
1286 * struct cfg80211_mbssid_config - AP settings for multi bssid
1287 *
1288 * @tx_wdev: pointer to the transmitted interface in the MBSSID set
1289 * @index: index of this AP in the multi bssid group.
1290 * @ema: set to true if the beacons should be sent out in EMA mode.
1291 */
1292 struct cfg80211_mbssid_config {
1293 struct wireless_dev *tx_wdev;
1294 u8 index;
1295 bool ema;
1296 };
1297
1298 /**
1299 * struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems - Multiple BSSID elements
1300 *
1301 * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems.
1302 *
1303 * @elem: Array of multiple BSSID element(s) to be added into Beacon frames.
1304 * @elem.data: Data for multiple BSSID elements.
1305 * @elem.len: Length of data.
1306 */
1307 struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems {
1308 u8 cnt;
1309 struct {
1310 const u8 *data;
1311 size_t len;
1312 } elem[] __counted_by(cnt);
1313 };
1314
1315 /**
1316 * struct cfg80211_rnr_elems - Reduced neighbor report (RNR) elements
1317 *
1318 * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems.
1319 *
1320 * @elem: Array of RNR element(s) to be added into Beacon frames.
1321 * @elem.data: Data for RNR elements.
1322 * @elem.len: Length of data.
1323 */
1324 struct cfg80211_rnr_elems {
1325 u8 cnt;
1326 struct {
1327 const u8 *data;
1328 size_t len;
1329 } elem[] __counted_by(cnt);
1330 };
1331
1332 /**
1333 * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data
1334 * @link_id: the link ID for the AP MLD link sending this beacon
1335 * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE)
1336 * or %NULL if not changed
1337 * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE)
1338 * or %NULL if not changed
1339 * @head_len: length of @head
1340 * @tail_len: length of @tail
1341 * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL
1342 * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets
1343 * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response
1344 * frames or %NULL
1345 * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets
1346 * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association
1347 * Response frames or %NULL
1348 * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets
1349 * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp)
1350 * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only)
1351 * @mbssid_ies: multiple BSSID elements
1352 * @rnr_ies: reduced neighbor report elements
1353 * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change
1354 * (which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data)
1355 * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token
1356 * (measurement type 8)
1357 * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement
1358 * Token (measurement type 11)
1359 * @lci_len: LCI data length
1360 * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length
1361 * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings
1362 * @he_bss_color_valid: indicates whether bss color
1363 * attribute is present in beacon data or not.
1364 */
1365 struct cfg80211_beacon_data {
1366 unsigned int link_id;
1367
1368 const u8 *head, *tail;
1369 const u8 *beacon_ies;
1370 const u8 *proberesp_ies;
1371 const u8 *assocresp_ies;
1372 const u8 *probe_resp;
1373 const u8 *lci;
1374 const u8 *civicloc;
1375 struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems *mbssid_ies;
1376 struct cfg80211_rnr_elems *rnr_ies;
1377 s8 ftm_responder;
1378
1379 size_t head_len, tail_len;
1380 size_t beacon_ies_len;
1381 size_t proberesp_ies_len;
1382 size_t assocresp_ies_len;
1383 size_t probe_resp_len;
1384 size_t lci_len;
1385 size_t civicloc_len;
1386 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
1387 bool he_bss_color_valid;
1388 };
1389
1390 struct mac_address {
1391 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
1392 };
1393
1394 /**
1395 * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data
1396 *
1397 * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's
1398 * entry specified by mac_addr
1399 * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed
1400 * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL
1401 */
1402 struct cfg80211_acl_data {
1403 enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy;
1404 int n_acl_entries;
1405
1406 /* Keep it last */
1407 struct mac_address mac_addrs[] __counted_by(n_acl_entries);
1408 };
1409
1410 /**
1411 * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
1412 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
1413 *
1414 * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated.
1415 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1416 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1417 * @tmpl_len: Template length
1418 * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action
1419 * frame headers.
1420 */
1421 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery {
1422 bool update;
1423 u32 min_interval;
1424 u32 max_interval;
1425 size_t tmpl_len;
1426 const u8 *tmpl;
1427 };
1428
1429 /**
1430 * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe
1431 * response parameters in 6GHz.
1432 *
1433 * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated.
1434 * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned
1435 * in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive
1436 * scanning
1437 * @tmpl_len: Template length
1438 * @tmpl: Template data for probe response
1439 */
1440 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp {
1441 bool update;
1442 u32 interval;
1443 size_t tmpl_len;
1444 const u8 *tmpl;
1445 };
1446
1447 /**
1448 * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration
1449 *
1450 * Used to configure an AP interface.
1451 *
1452 * @chandef: defines the channel to use
1453 * @beacon: beacon data
1454 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1455 * @dtim_period: DTIM period
1456 * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from
1457 * user space)
1458 * @ssid_len: length of @ssid
1459 * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames
1460 * @crypto: crypto settings
1461 * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy
1462 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
1463 * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity.
1464 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window
1465 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS
1466 * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for
1467 * MAC address based access control
1468 * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG
1469 * networks.
1470 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
1471 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled)
1472 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled)
1473 * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1474 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled)
1475 * @eht_oper: EHT operation IE (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled)
1476 * @ht_required: stations must support HT
1477 * @vht_required: stations must support VHT
1478 * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time
1479 * @he_required: stations must support HE
1480 * @sae_h2e_required: stations must support direct H2E technique in SAE
1481 * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags
1482 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings
1483 * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1484 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1485 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1486 * @mbssid_config: AP settings for multiple bssid
1487 */
1488 struct cfg80211_ap_settings {
1489 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1490
1491 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1492
1493 int beacon_interval, dtim_period;
1494 const u8 *ssid;
1495 size_t ssid_len;
1496 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid;
1497 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
1498 bool privacy;
1499 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
1500 int inactivity_timeout;
1501 u8 p2p_ctwindow;
1502 bool p2p_opp_ps;
1503 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl;
1504 bool pbss;
1505 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
1506
1507 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap;
1508 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap;
1509 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap;
1510 const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper;
1511 const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_cap;
1512 const struct ieee80211_eht_operation *eht_oper;
1513 bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required, sae_h2e_required;
1514 bool twt_responder;
1515 u32 flags;
1516 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
1517 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1518 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1519 struct cfg80211_mbssid_config mbssid_config;
1520 };
1521
1522
1523 /**
1524 * struct cfg80211_ap_update - AP configuration update
1525 *
1526 * Subset of &struct cfg80211_ap_settings, for updating a running AP.
1527 *
1528 * @beacon: beacon data
1529 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1530 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1531 */
1532 struct cfg80211_ap_update {
1533 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1534 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1535 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1536 };
1537
1538 /**
1539 * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings
1540 *
1541 * Used for channel switch
1542 *
1543 * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch
1544 * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch
1545 * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1546 * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1547 * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail)
1548 * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response
1549 * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel
1550 * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel
1551 * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing
1552 * @count: number of beacons until switch
1553 * @link_id: defines the link on which channel switch is expected during
1554 * MLO. 0 in case of non-MLO.
1555 */
1556 struct cfg80211_csa_settings {
1557 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1558 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa;
1559 const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon;
1560 const u16 *counter_offsets_presp;
1561 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon;
1562 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp;
1563 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after;
1564 bool radar_required;
1565 bool block_tx;
1566 u8 count;
1567 u8 link_id;
1568 };
1569
1570 /**
1571 * struct cfg80211_color_change_settings - color change settings
1572 *
1573 * Used for bss color change
1574 *
1575 * @beacon_color_change: beacon data while performing the color countdown
1576 * @counter_offset_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1577 * @counter_offset_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1578 * @beacon_next: beacon data to be used after the color change
1579 * @count: number of beacons until the color change
1580 * @color: the color used after the change
1581 * @link_id: defines the link on which color change is expected during MLO.
1582 * 0 in case of non-MLO.
1583 */
1584 struct cfg80211_color_change_settings {
1585 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_color_change;
1586 u16 counter_offset_beacon;
1587 u16 counter_offset_presp;
1588 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_next;
1589 u8 count;
1590 u8 color;
1591 u8 link_id;
1592 };
1593
1594 /**
1595 * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations
1596 *
1597 * Used to pass interface combination parameters
1598 *
1599 * @radio_idx: wiphy radio index or -1 for global
1600 * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want
1601 * to use for verification
1602 * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel
1603 * width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of
1604 * &struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths
1605 * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface
1606 * type. The index is the interface type as specified in &enum
1607 * nl80211_iftype.
1608 * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface
1609 * that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of
1610 * the verification
1611 */
1612 struct iface_combination_params {
1613 int radio_idx;
1614 int num_different_channels;
1615 u8 radar_detect;
1616 int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES];
1617 u32 new_beacon_int;
1618 };
1619
1620 /**
1621 * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply
1622 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp)
1623 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability
1624 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state
1625 *
1626 * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling,
1627 * for those that don't these flags will are used.
1628 */
1629 enum station_parameters_apply_mask {
1630 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0),
1631 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1),
1632 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2),
1633 };
1634
1635 /**
1636 * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
1637 *
1638 * Used to configure txpower for station.
1639 *
1640 * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power
1641 * is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be
1642 * overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx
1643 * power per-interface or per-station.
1644 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
1645 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
1646 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
1647 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
1648 * per peer TPC.
1649 */
1650 struct sta_txpwr {
1651 s16 power;
1652 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
1653 };
1654
1655 /**
1656 * struct link_station_parameters - link station parameters
1657 *
1658 * Used to change and create a new link station.
1659 *
1660 * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station
1661 * @link_id: the link id (-1 for non-MLD station)
1662 * @link_mac: MAC address of the link
1663 * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format
1664 * (or NULL for no change)
1665 * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates
1666 * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station
1667 * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station
1668 * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification
1669 * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used
1670 * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station
1671 * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities
1672 * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station
1673 * @txpwr_set: txpwr field is set
1674 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station
1675 * @eht_capa: EHT capabilities of station
1676 * @eht_capa_len: the length of the EHT capabilities
1677 */
1678 struct link_station_parameters {
1679 const u8 *mld_mac;
1680 int link_id;
1681 const u8 *link_mac;
1682 const u8 *supported_rates;
1683 u8 supported_rates_len;
1684 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa;
1685 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa;
1686 u8 opmode_notif;
1687 bool opmode_notif_used;
1688 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa;
1689 u8 he_capa_len;
1690 struct sta_txpwr txpwr;
1691 bool txpwr_set;
1692 const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa;
1693 const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_capa;
1694 u8 eht_capa_len;
1695 };
1696
1697 /**
1698 * struct link_station_del_parameters - link station deletion parameters
1699 *
1700 * Used to delete a link station entry (or all stations).
1701 *
1702 * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station
1703 * @link_id: the link id
1704 */
1705 struct link_station_del_parameters {
1706 const u8 *mld_mac;
1707 u32 link_id;
1708 };
1709
1710 /**
1711 * struct cfg80211_ttlm_params: TID to link mapping parameters
1712 *
1713 * Used for setting a TID to link mapping.
1714 *
1715 * @dlink: Downlink TID to link mapping, as defined in section 9.4.2.314
1716 * (TID-To-Link Mapping element) in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
1717 * @ulink: Uplink TID to link mapping, as defined in section 9.4.2.314
1718 * (TID-To-Link Mapping element) in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
1719 */
1720 struct cfg80211_ttlm_params {
1721 u16 dlink[8];
1722 u16 ulink[8];
1723 };
1724
1725 /**
1726 * struct station_parameters - station parameters
1727 *
1728 * Used to change and create a new station.
1729 *
1730 * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to
1731 * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed
1732 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1733 * @sta_flags_set: station flags values
1734 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1735 * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change
1736 * @aid: AID or zero for no change
1737 * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero)
1738 * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change
1739 * @plink_action: plink action to take
1740 * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station
1741 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format
1742 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
1743 * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the
1744 * QoS info field (but already shifted down)
1745 * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed
1746 * (for those that don't have a natural "no change" value),
1747 * see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask
1748 * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set
1749 * to unknown)
1750 * @capability: station capability
1751 * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station
1752 * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities
1753 * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format
1754 * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels
1755 * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format
1756 * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes
1757 * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism
1758 * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station
1759 * @link_sta_params: link related params.
1760 */
1761 struct station_parameters {
1762 struct net_device *vlan;
1763 u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set;
1764 u32 sta_modify_mask;
1765 int listen_interval;
1766 u16 aid;
1767 u16 vlan_id;
1768 u16 peer_aid;
1769 u8 plink_action;
1770 u8 plink_state;
1771 u8 uapsd_queues;
1772 u8 max_sp;
1773 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1774 u16 capability;
1775 const u8 *ext_capab;
1776 u8 ext_capab_len;
1777 const u8 *supported_channels;
1778 u8 supported_channels_len;
1779 const u8 *supported_oper_classes;
1780 u8 supported_oper_classes_len;
1781 int support_p2p_ps;
1782 u16 airtime_weight;
1783 struct link_station_parameters link_sta_params;
1784 };
1785
1786 /**
1787 * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters
1788 *
1789 * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations).
1790 *
1791 * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations
1792 * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal
1793 * (10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication)
1794 * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame
1795 * @link_id: Link ID indicating a link that stations to be flushed must be
1796 * using; valid only for MLO, but can also be -1 for MLO to really
1797 * remove all stations.
1798 */
1799 struct station_del_parameters {
1800 const u8 *mac;
1801 u8 subtype;
1802 u16 reason_code;
1803 int link_id;
1804 };
1805
1806 /**
1807 * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified
1808 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface
1809 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still
1810 * unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted)
1811 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has
1812 * the AP MLME in the device
1813 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface
1814 * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station
1815 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry
1816 * while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when
1817 * being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is
1818 * supported/used)
1819 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active
1820 * entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace)
1821 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed)
1822 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed)
1823 */
1824 enum cfg80211_station_type {
1825 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT,
1826 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC,
1827 CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT,
1828 CFG80211_STA_AP_STA,
1829 CFG80211_STA_IBSS,
1830 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP,
1831 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE,
1832 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL,
1833 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER,
1834 };
1835
1836 /**
1837 * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes
1838 * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on
1839 * @params: the new parameters for a station
1840 * @statype: the type of station being modified
1841 *
1842 * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function
1843 * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that
1844 * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable.
1845 *
1846 * Return: 0 if the change is acceptable, otherwise an error code. Note that
1847 * it may modify the parameters for backward compatibility reasons, so don't
1848 * use them before calling this.
1849 */
1850 int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1851 struct station_parameters *params,
1852 enum cfg80211_station_type statype);
1853
1854 /**
1855 * enum rate_info_flags - bitrate info flags
1856 *
1857 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1858 * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1859 *
1860 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS
1861 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS
1862 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
1863 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS
1864 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information
1865 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode
1866 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG: 60GHz extended SC MCS
1867 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS information
1868 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS: MCS field filled with S1G MCS
1869 */
1870 enum rate_info_flags {
1871 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS = BIT(0),
1872 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS = BIT(1),
1873 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI = BIT(2),
1874 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG = BIT(3),
1875 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS = BIT(4),
1876 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG = BIT(5),
1877 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG = BIT(6),
1878 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS = BIT(7),
1879 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS = BIT(8),
1880 };
1881
1882 /**
1883 * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information
1884 *
1885 * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth.
1886 *
1887 * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth
1888 * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth
1889 * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth
1890 * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth
1891 * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth
1892 * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth
1893 * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation
1894 * @RATE_INFO_BW_320: 320 MHz bandwidth
1895 * @RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU: bandwidth determined by EHT RU allocation
1896 * @RATE_INFO_BW_1: 1 MHz bandwidth
1897 * @RATE_INFO_BW_2: 2 MHz bandwidth
1898 * @RATE_INFO_BW_4: 4 MHz bandwidth
1899 * @RATE_INFO_BW_8: 8 MHz bandwidth
1900 * @RATE_INFO_BW_16: 16 MHz bandwidth
1901 */
1902 enum rate_info_bw {
1903 RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0,
1904 RATE_INFO_BW_5,
1905 RATE_INFO_BW_10,
1906 RATE_INFO_BW_40,
1907 RATE_INFO_BW_80,
1908 RATE_INFO_BW_160,
1909 RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU,
1910 RATE_INFO_BW_320,
1911 RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU,
1912 RATE_INFO_BW_1,
1913 RATE_INFO_BW_2,
1914 RATE_INFO_BW_4,
1915 RATE_INFO_BW_8,
1916 RATE_INFO_BW_16,
1917 };
1918
1919 /**
1920 * struct rate_info - bitrate information
1921 *
1922 * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate
1923 *
1924 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags
1925 * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg
1926 * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE/EHT/S1G rate
1927 * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only)
1928 * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw)
1929 * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi)
1930 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1931 * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc,
1932 * only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU)
1933 * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4)
1934 * @eht_gi: EHT guard interval (from &enum nl80211_eht_gi)
1935 * @eht_ru_alloc: EHT RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc,
1936 * only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU)
1937 */
1938 struct rate_info {
1939 u16 flags;
1940 u16 legacy;
1941 u8 mcs;
1942 u8 nss;
1943 u8 bw;
1944 u8 he_gi;
1945 u8 he_dcm;
1946 u8 he_ru_alloc;
1947 u8 n_bonded_ch;
1948 u8 eht_gi;
1949 u8 eht_ru_alloc;
1950 };
1951
1952 /**
1953 * enum bss_param_flags - bitrate info flags
1954 *
1955 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1956 * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1957 *
1958 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled
1959 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1960 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled
1961 */
1962 enum bss_param_flags {
1963 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT = BIT(0),
1964 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE = BIT(1),
1965 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME = BIT(2),
1966 };
1967
1968 /**
1969 * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station
1970 *
1971 * Information about the currently associated BSS
1972 *
1973 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags
1974 * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS
1975 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1976 */
1977 struct sta_bss_parameters {
1978 u8 flags;
1979 u8 dtim_period;
1980 u16 beacon_interval;
1981 };
1982
1983 /**
1984 * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID
1985 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to
1986 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1987 * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged
1988 * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged
1989 * @flows: number of new flows seen
1990 * @drops: total number of packets dropped
1991 * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE
1992 * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow
1993 * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
1994 * @collisions: number of hash collisions
1995 * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued
1996 * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued
1997 * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported
1998 */
1999 struct cfg80211_txq_stats {
2000 u32 filled;
2001 u32 backlog_bytes;
2002 u32 backlog_packets;
2003 u32 flows;
2004 u32 drops;
2005 u32 ecn_marks;
2006 u32 overlimit;
2007 u32 overmemory;
2008 u32 collisions;
2009 u32 tx_bytes;
2010 u32 tx_packets;
2011 u32 max_flows;
2012 };
2013
2014 /**
2015 * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics
2016 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to
2017 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
2018 * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs
2019 * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs
2020 * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for
2021 * transmitted MSDUs
2022 * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs
2023 * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics
2024 */
2025 struct cfg80211_tid_stats {
2026 u32 filled;
2027 u64 rx_msdu;
2028 u64 tx_msdu;
2029 u64 tx_msdu_retries;
2030 u64 tx_msdu_failed;
2031 struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats;
2032 };
2033
2034 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS 4
2035
2036 /**
2037 * struct station_info - station information
2038 *
2039 * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station.
2040 *
2041 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to
2042 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
2043 * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected
2044 * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds
2045 * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association
2046 * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station
2047 * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station
2048 * @llid: mesh local link id
2049 * @plid: mesh peer link id
2050 * @plink_state: mesh peer link state
2051 * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
2052 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
2053 * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
2054 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
2055 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg
2056 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm
2057 * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm
2058 * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station
2059 * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station
2060 * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station
2061 * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station
2062 * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs)
2063 * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK)
2064 * @rx_dropped_misc: Dropped for un-specified reason.
2065 * @bss_param: current BSS parameters
2066 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
2067 * This number should increase every time the list of stations
2068 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
2069 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
2070 * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request.
2071 * This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use
2072 * user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for
2073 * the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs.
2074 * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets.
2075 * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values
2076 * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered.
2077 * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host.
2078 * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode
2079 * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode
2080 * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode
2081 * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers)
2082 * towards this station.
2083 * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer
2084 * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received
2085 * from this peer
2086 * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate
2087 * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer
2088 * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer
2089 * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight
2090 * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last
2091 * (IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs.
2092 * Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL.
2093 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame.
2094 * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has
2095 * been sent.
2096 * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station
2097 * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with
2098 * an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the
2099 * received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address.
2100 * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric.
2101 * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server
2102 * @mlo_params_valid: Indicates @assoc_link_id and @mld_addr fields are filled
2103 * by driver. Drivers use this only in cfg80211_new_sta() calls when AP
2104 * MLD's MLME/SME is offload to driver. Drivers won't fill this
2105 * information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and
2106 * dump_station() callbacks.
2107 * @assoc_link_id: Indicates MLO link ID of the AP, with which the station
2108 * completed (re)association. This information filled for both MLO
2109 * and non-MLO STA connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD.
2110 * @mld_addr: For MLO STA connection, filled with MLD address of the station.
2111 * For non-MLO STA connection, filled with all zeros.
2112 * @assoc_resp_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Response.
2113 * This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use user
2114 * space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided only for the
2115 * cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. Drivers won't
2116 * fill this information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and
2117 * dump_station() callbacks. User space needs this information to determine
2118 * the accepted and rejected affiliated links of the connected station.
2119 * @assoc_resp_ies_len: Length of @assoc_resp_ies buffer in octets.
2120 */
2121 struct station_info {
2122 u64 filled;
2123 u32 connected_time;
2124 u32 inactive_time;
2125 u64 assoc_at;
2126 u64 rx_bytes;
2127 u64 tx_bytes;
2128 u16 llid;
2129 u16 plid;
2130 u8 plink_state;
2131 s8 signal;
2132 s8 signal_avg;
2133
2134 u8 chains;
2135 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2136 s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2137
2138 struct rate_info txrate;
2139 struct rate_info rxrate;
2140 u32 rx_packets;
2141 u32 tx_packets;
2142 u32 tx_retries;
2143 u32 tx_failed;
2144 u32 rx_dropped_misc;
2145 struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param;
2146 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags;
2147
2148 int generation;
2149
2150 const u8 *assoc_req_ies;
2151 size_t assoc_req_ies_len;
2152
2153 u32 beacon_loss_count;
2154 s64 t_offset;
2155 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
2156 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm;
2157 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm;
2158
2159 u32 expected_throughput;
2160
2161 u64 tx_duration;
2162 u64 rx_duration;
2163 u64 rx_beacon;
2164 u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg;
2165 u8 connected_to_gate;
2166
2167 struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid;
2168 s8 ack_signal;
2169 s8 avg_ack_signal;
2170
2171 u16 airtime_weight;
2172
2173 u32 rx_mpdu_count;
2174 u32 fcs_err_count;
2175
2176 u32 airtime_link_metric;
2177
2178 u8 connected_to_as;
2179
2180 bool mlo_params_valid;
2181 u8 assoc_link_id;
2182 u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2183 const u8 *assoc_resp_ies;
2184 size_t assoc_resp_ies_len;
2185 };
2186
2187 /**
2188 * struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs - sub specs limit
2189 * @power: power limitation in 0.25dbm
2190 * @freq_range_index: index the power limitation applies to
2191 */
2192 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs {
2193 s32 power;
2194 u32 freq_range_index;
2195 };
2196
2197 /**
2198 * struct cfg80211_sar_specs - sar limit specs
2199 * @type: it's set with power in 0.25dbm or other types
2200 * @num_sub_specs: number of sar sub specs
2201 * @sub_specs: memory to hold the sar sub specs
2202 */
2203 struct cfg80211_sar_specs {
2204 enum nl80211_sar_type type;
2205 u32 num_sub_specs;
2206 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs sub_specs[] __counted_by(num_sub_specs);
2207 };
2208
2209
2210 /**
2211 * struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges - sar frequency ranges
2212 * @start_freq: start range edge frequency
2213 * @end_freq: end range edge frequency
2214 */
2215 struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges {
2216 u32 start_freq;
2217 u32 end_freq;
2218 };
2219
2220 /**
2221 * struct cfg80211_sar_capa - sar limit capability
2222 * @type: it's set via power in 0.25dbm or other types
2223 * @num_freq_ranges: number of frequency ranges
2224 * @freq_ranges: memory to hold the freq ranges.
2225 *
2226 * Note: WLAN driver may append new ranges or split an existing
2227 * range to small ones and then append them.
2228 */
2229 struct cfg80211_sar_capa {
2230 enum nl80211_sar_type type;
2231 u32 num_freq_ranges;
2232 const struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges *freq_ranges;
2233 };
2234
2235 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
2236 /**
2237 * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station
2238 * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to
2239 * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest
2240 * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information
2241 *
2242 * Return: 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information
2243 * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be
2244 * considered undefined.
2245 */
2246 int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
2247 struct station_info *sinfo);
2248 #else
cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * mac_addr,struct station_info * sinfo)2249 static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev,
2250 const u8 *mac_addr,
2251 struct station_info *sinfo)
2252 {
2253 return -ENOENT;
2254 }
2255 #endif
2256
2257 /**
2258 * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags
2259 *
2260 * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits
2261 * according to the nl80211 flags.
2262 *
2263 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed
2264 * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
2265 * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
2266 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
2267 * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
2268 * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing
2269 * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address
2270 * @MONITOR_FLAG_SKIP_TX: do not pass locally transmitted frames
2271 */
2272 enum monitor_flags {
2273 MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED = BIT(__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID),
2274 MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL = BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL),
2275 MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL = BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL),
2276 MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL = BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL),
2277 MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS = BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS),
2278 MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES = BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES),
2279 MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE = BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE),
2280 MONITOR_FLAG_SKIP_TX = BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_SKIP_TX),
2281 };
2282
2283 /**
2284 * enum mpath_info_flags - mesh path information flags
2285 *
2286 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled
2287 * in during get_station() or dump_station().
2288 *
2289 * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled
2290 * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled
2291 * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled
2292 * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled
2293 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled
2294 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled
2295 * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled
2296 * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled
2297 * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled
2298 */
2299 enum mpath_info_flags {
2300 MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN = BIT(0),
2301 MPATH_INFO_SN = BIT(1),
2302 MPATH_INFO_METRIC = BIT(2),
2303 MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME = BIT(3),
2304 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT = BIT(4),
2305 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES = BIT(5),
2306 MPATH_INFO_FLAGS = BIT(6),
2307 MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT = BIT(7),
2308 MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE = BIT(8),
2309 };
2310
2311 /**
2312 * struct mpath_info - mesh path information
2313 *
2314 * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath().
2315 *
2316 * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags
2317 * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination
2318 * @sn: target sequence number
2319 * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path
2320 * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs
2321 * @flags: mesh path flags from &enum mesh_path_flags
2322 * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs
2323 * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries
2324 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
2325 * This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths
2326 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
2327 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
2328 * @hop_count: hops to destination
2329 * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination
2330 */
2331 struct mpath_info {
2332 u32 filled;
2333 u32 frame_qlen;
2334 u32 sn;
2335 u32 metric;
2336 u32 exptime;
2337 u32 discovery_timeout;
2338 u8 discovery_retries;
2339 u8 flags;
2340 u8 hop_count;
2341 u32 path_change_count;
2342
2343 int generation;
2344 };
2345
2346 /**
2347 * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters
2348 *
2349 * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode).
2350 *
2351 * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD
2352 * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection
2353 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2354 * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed
2355 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2356 * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed
2357 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2358 * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format
2359 * (or NULL for no change)
2360 * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates
2361 * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations
2362 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2363 * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode
2364 * (u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change)
2365 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change)
2366 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change)
2367 */
2368 struct bss_parameters {
2369 int link_id;
2370 int use_cts_prot;
2371 int use_short_preamble;
2372 int use_short_slot_time;
2373 const u8 *basic_rates;
2374 u8 basic_rates_len;
2375 int ap_isolate;
2376 int ht_opmode;
2377 s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps;
2378 };
2379
2380 /**
2381 * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration
2382 *
2383 * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active.
2384 *
2385 * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used
2386 * by the Mesh Peering Open message
2387 * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units
2388 * used by the Mesh Peering Open message
2389 * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by
2390 * the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering
2391 * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this
2392 * mesh interface
2393 * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can
2394 * be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh
2395 * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA
2396 * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection
2397 * elements
2398 * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we
2399 * detect compatible mesh peers
2400 * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to
2401 * synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
2402 * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ
2403 * that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target
2404 * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds
2405 * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on
2406 * a path discovery in milliseconds
2407 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
2408 * receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the
2409 * root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
2410 * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
2411 * which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
2412 * element
2413 * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
2414 * which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR
2415 * element
2416 * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that
2417 * it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh
2418 * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA
2419 * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root
2420 * announcements are transmitted
2421 * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh
2422 * station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is
2423 * missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true
2424 * only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but
2425 * not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the
2426 * same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec)
2427 * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding
2428 * entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
2429 * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate
2430 * station to establish a peer link
2431 * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode
2432 *
2433 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
2434 * receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to
2435 * the root mesh STA to be valid.
2436 *
2437 * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive
2438 * PREQs are transmitted.
2439 * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs)
2440 * during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing
2441 * a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
2442 * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial
2443 * setting for new peer links.
2444 * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake
2445 * after transmitting its beacon.
2446 * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established
2447 * peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it
2448 * from the STA's list of peers. Default is 30 minutes.
2449 * @dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer: if set to true then this mesh STA
2450 * will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server
2451 * in the mesh formation field.
2452 * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is
2453 * connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info. If false, the
2454 * value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths
2455 * in the mesh path table
2456 * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP
2457 * for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might
2458 * not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So
2459 * if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
2460 * dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
2461 */
2462 struct mesh_config {
2463 u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout;
2464 u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout;
2465 u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout;
2466 u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks;
2467 u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries;
2468 u8 dot11MeshTTL;
2469 u8 element_ttl;
2470 bool auto_open_plinks;
2471 u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor;
2472 u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries;
2473 u32 path_refresh_time;
2474 u16 min_discovery_timeout;
2475 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout;
2476 u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval;
2477 u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval;
2478 u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime;
2479 u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode;
2480 bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate;
2481 bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer;
2482 u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval;
2483 bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol;
2484 bool dot11MeshForwarding;
2485 s32 rssi_threshold;
2486 u16 ht_opmode;
2487 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout;
2488 u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval;
2489 u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval;
2490 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode;
2491 u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration;
2492 u32 plink_timeout;
2493 bool dot11MeshNolearn;
2494 };
2495
2496 /**
2497 * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration
2498 * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2499 * @mesh_id: the mesh ID
2500 * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes
2501 * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use
2502 * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use
2503 * @path_metric: which metric to use
2504 * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using
2505 * @ie: vendor information elements (optional)
2506 * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements
2507 * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication
2508 * @is_secure: this mesh uses security
2509 * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions
2510 * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use
2511 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
2512 * @mcast_rate: multicast rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a]
2513 * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh
2514 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
2515 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
2516 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
2517 * to operate on DFS channels.
2518 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
2519 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
2520 *
2521 * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created.
2522 */
2523 struct mesh_setup {
2524 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2525 const u8 *mesh_id;
2526 u8 mesh_id_len;
2527 u8 sync_method;
2528 u8 path_sel_proto;
2529 u8 path_metric;
2530 u8 auth_id;
2531 const u8 *ie;
2532 u8 ie_len;
2533 bool is_authenticated;
2534 bool is_secure;
2535 bool user_mpm;
2536 u8 dtim_period;
2537 u16 beacon_interval;
2538 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2539 u32 basic_rates;
2540 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
2541 bool userspace_handles_dfs;
2542 bool control_port_over_nl80211;
2543 };
2544
2545 /**
2546 * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration
2547 * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2548 *
2549 * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network
2550 */
2551 struct ocb_setup {
2552 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2553 };
2554
2555 /**
2556 * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters
2557 * @ac: AC identifier
2558 * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
2559 * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2560 * 1..32767]
2561 * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2562 * 1..32767]
2563 * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
2564 * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD
2565 */
2566 struct ieee80211_txq_params {
2567 enum nl80211_ac ac;
2568 u16 txop;
2569 u16 cwmin;
2570 u16 cwmax;
2571 u8 aifs;
2572 int link_id;
2573 };
2574
2575 /**
2576 * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling
2577 *
2578 * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite
2579 * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will
2580 * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the
2581 * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the
2582 * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to
2583 * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements
2584 * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be
2585 * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised
2586 * in the wiphy structure.
2587 *
2588 * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because
2589 * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not
2590 * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist.
2591 *
2592 * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of
2593 * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the
2594 * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available
2595 * to userspace.
2596 */
2597
2598 /**
2599 * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description
2600 * @ssid: the SSID
2601 * @ssid_len: length of the ssid
2602 */
2603 struct cfg80211_ssid {
2604 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
2605 u8 ssid_len;
2606 };
2607
2608 /**
2609 * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan
2610 * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the
2611 * wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this
2612 * information is not available, this field is left zero.
2613 * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set.
2614 * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason,
2615 * userspace will be notified of that
2616 */
2617 struct cfg80211_scan_info {
2618 u64 scan_start_tsf;
2619 u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2620 bool aborted;
2621 };
2622
2623 /**
2624 * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only
2625 *
2626 * @short_ssid: short ssid to scan for
2627 * @bssid: bssid to scan for
2628 * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request
2629 * which the above info is relevant to
2630 * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU
2631 * @short_ssid_valid: @short_ssid is valid and can be used
2632 * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait
2633 * 20 TUs before starting to send probe requests.
2634 * @psd_20: The AP's 20 MHz PSD value.
2635 */
2636 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params {
2637 u32 short_ssid;
2638 u32 channel_idx;
2639 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2640 bool unsolicited_probe;
2641 bool short_ssid_valid;
2642 bool psc_no_listen;
2643 s8 psd_20;
2644 };
2645
2646 /**
2647 * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description
2648 *
2649 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only)
2650 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2651 * @channels: channels to scan on.
2652 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2653 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2654 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2655 * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If
2656 * %duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and
2657 * the actual dwell time may be shorter.
2658 * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the
2659 * %duration field.
2660 * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags
2661 * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band
2662 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2663 * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started
2664 * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for
2665 * @info: (internal) information about completed scan
2666 * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted
2667 * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band
2668 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2669 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2670 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2671 * be taken from the @mac_addr
2672 * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only,
2673 * true if this is the second scan request
2674 * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params
2675 * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params
2676 * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID)
2677 * @tsf_report_link_id: for MLO, indicates the link ID of the BSS that should be
2678 * used for TSF reporting. Can be set to -1 to indicate no preference.
2679 */
2680 struct cfg80211_scan_request {
2681 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2682 int n_ssids;
2683 u32 n_channels;
2684 const u8 *ie;
2685 size_t ie_len;
2686 u16 duration;
2687 bool duration_mandatory;
2688 u32 flags;
2689
2690 u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2691
2692 struct wireless_dev *wdev;
2693
2694 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2695 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2696 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2697
2698 /* internal */
2699 struct wiphy *wiphy;
2700 unsigned long scan_start;
2701 struct cfg80211_scan_info info;
2702 bool notified;
2703 bool no_cck;
2704 bool scan_6ghz;
2705 u32 n_6ghz_params;
2706 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params;
2707 s8 tsf_report_link_id;
2708
2709 /* keep last */
2710 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[] __counted_by(n_channels);
2711 };
2712
get_random_mask_addr(u8 * buf,const u8 * addr,const u8 * mask)2713 static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask)
2714 {
2715 int i;
2716
2717 get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN);
2718 for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) {
2719 buf[i] &= ~mask[i];
2720 buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i];
2721 }
2722 }
2723
2724 /**
2725 * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match
2726 *
2727 * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match
2728 * or no match (RSSI only)
2729 * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match
2730 * or no match (RSSI only)
2731 * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm)
2732 */
2733 struct cfg80211_match_set {
2734 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
2735 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2736 s32 rssi_thold;
2737 };
2738
2739 /**
2740 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan
2741 *
2742 * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds.
2743 * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means
2744 * infinite loop.
2745 * The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero,
2746 * all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations.
2747 */
2748 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan {
2749 u32 interval;
2750 u32 iterations;
2751 };
2752
2753 /**
2754 * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment.
2755 *
2756 * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment.
2757 * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment.
2758 */
2759 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust {
2760 enum nl80211_band band;
2761 s8 delta;
2762 };
2763
2764 /**
2765 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description
2766 *
2767 * @reqid: identifies this request.
2768 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans)
2769 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2770 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2771 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2772 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2773 * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags
2774 * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result
2775 * entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host
2776 * (others are filtered out).
2777 * If omitted, all results are passed.
2778 * @n_match_sets: number of match sets
2779 * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request
2780 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2781 * @dev: the interface
2782 * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan
2783 * @channels: channels to scan
2784 * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this
2785 * contains the minimum over all matchsets
2786 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2787 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2788 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2789 * be taken from the @mac_addr
2790 * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest
2791 * index must be executed first.
2792 * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1.
2793 * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct
2794 * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request
2795 * owned by a particular socket)
2796 * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed
2797 * @list: for keeping list of requests.
2798 * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan
2799 * cycle. The driver may ignore this parameter and start
2800 * immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not
2801 * supported.
2802 * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not.
2803 * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result
2804 * reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined
2805 * to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS.
2806 * The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state.
2807 * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong
2808 * to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported
2809 * using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that
2810 * belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative
2811 * comparisons.
2812 */
2813 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request {
2814 u64 reqid;
2815 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2816 int n_ssids;
2817 u32 n_channels;
2818 const u8 *ie;
2819 size_t ie_len;
2820 u32 flags;
2821 struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets;
2822 int n_match_sets;
2823 s32 min_rssi_thold;
2824 u32 delay;
2825 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans;
2826 int n_scan_plans;
2827
2828 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2829 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2830
2831 bool relative_rssi_set;
2832 s8 relative_rssi;
2833 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust;
2834
2835 /* internal */
2836 struct wiphy *wiphy;
2837 struct net_device *dev;
2838 unsigned long scan_start;
2839 bool report_results;
2840 struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2841 u32 owner_nlportid;
2842 bool nl_owner_dead;
2843 struct list_head list;
2844
2845 /* keep last */
2846 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[] __counted_by(n_channels);
2847 };
2848
2849 /**
2850 * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type
2851 *
2852 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available
2853 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm)
2854 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100
2855 */
2856 enum cfg80211_signal_type {
2857 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE,
2858 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM,
2859 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC,
2860 };
2861
2862 /**
2863 * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data
2864 * @chan: channel the frame was received on
2865 * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's
2866 * signal type
2867 * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was
2868 * received; should match the time when the frame was actually
2869 * received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was
2870 * buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms.
2871 * If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of
2872 * ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate.
2873 * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the
2874 * timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified
2875 * by %parent_bssid.
2876 * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to
2877 * the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received.
2878 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2879 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2880 * @restrict_use: restrict usage, if not set, assume @use_for is
2881 * %NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL.
2882 * @use_for: bitmap of possible usage for this BSS, see
2883 * &enum nl80211_bss_use_for
2884 * @cannot_use_reasons: the reasons (bitmap) for not being able to connect,
2885 * if @restrict_use is set and @use_for is zero (empty); may be 0 for
2886 * unspecified reasons; see &enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons
2887 * @drv_data: Data to be passed through to @inform_bss
2888 */
2889 struct cfg80211_inform_bss {
2890 struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
2891 s32 signal;
2892 u64 boottime_ns;
2893 u64 parent_tsf;
2894 u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2895 u8 chains;
2896 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2897
2898 u8 restrict_use:1, use_for:7;
2899 u8 cannot_use_reasons;
2900
2901 void *drv_data;
2902 };
2903
2904 /**
2905 * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data
2906 * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs
2907 * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing
2908 * @len: length of the IEs
2909 * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon
2910 * @data: IE data
2911 */
2912 struct cfg80211_bss_ies {
2913 u64 tsf;
2914 struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2915 int len;
2916 bool from_beacon;
2917 u8 data[];
2918 };
2919
2920 /**
2921 * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description
2922 *
2923 * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network)
2924 * for use in scan results and similar.
2925 *
2926 * @channel: channel this BSS is on
2927 * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS
2928 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame
2929 * @capability: the capability field in host byte order
2930 * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these
2931 * are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or
2932 * proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been
2933 * received. It is always non-%NULL.
2934 * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame
2935 * (implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't
2936 * own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the
2937 * @hidden_beacon_bss struct)
2938 * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame
2939 * @proberesp_ecsa_stuck: ECSA element is stuck in the Probe Response frame,
2940 * cannot rely on it having valid data
2941 * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from
2942 * a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct
2943 * that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and
2944 * points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case.
2945 * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a
2946 * non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support)
2947 * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one
2948 * (multi-BSSID support)
2949 * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type)
2950 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2951 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2952 * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set
2953 * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set
2954 * @use_for: bitmap of possible usage for this BSS, see
2955 * &enum nl80211_bss_use_for
2956 * @cannot_use_reasons: the reasons (bitmap) for not being able to connect,
2957 * if @restrict_use is set and @use_for is zero (empty); may be 0 for
2958 * unspecified reasons; see &enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons
2959 * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes
2960 */
2961 struct cfg80211_bss {
2962 struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
2963
2964 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies;
2965 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies;
2966 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies;
2967
2968 struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss;
2969 struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss;
2970 struct list_head nontrans_list;
2971
2972 s32 signal;
2973
2974 u16 beacon_interval;
2975 u16 capability;
2976
2977 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2978 u8 chains;
2979 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2980
2981 u8 proberesp_ecsa_stuck:1;
2982
2983 u8 bssid_index;
2984 u8 max_bssid_indicator;
2985
2986 u8 use_for;
2987 u8 cannot_use_reasons;
2988
2989 u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2990 };
2991
2992 /**
2993 * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID
2994 * @bss: the bss to search
2995 * @id: the element ID
2996 *
2997 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2998 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2999 * Return: %NULL if not found.
3000 */
3001 const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id);
3002
3003 /**
3004 * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID
3005 * @bss: the bss to search
3006 * @id: the element ID
3007 *
3008 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
3009 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
3010 * Return: %NULL if not found.
3011 */
ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss * bss,u8 id)3012 static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id)
3013 {
3014 return (const void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id);
3015 }
3016
3017
3018 /**
3019 * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data
3020 *
3021 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3022 * authentication.
3023 *
3024 * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference
3025 * to it if it needs to keep it.
3026 * @supported_selectors: List of selectors that should be assumed to be
3027 * supported by the station.
3028 * SAE_H2E must be assumed supported if set to %NULL.
3029 * @supported_selectors_len: Length of supported_selectors in octets.
3030 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
3031 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL
3032 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3033 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
3034 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
3035 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
3036 * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains
3037 * the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the
3038 * Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication
3039 * transaction sequence number field.
3040 * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets
3041 * @link_id: if >= 0, indicates authentication should be done as an MLD,
3042 * the interface address is included as the MLD address and the
3043 * necessary link (with the given link_id) will be created (and
3044 * given an MLD address) by the driver
3045 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of authentication request with
3046 * an AP MLD, valid iff @link_id >= 0
3047 */
3048 struct cfg80211_auth_request {
3049 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3050 const u8 *ie;
3051 size_t ie_len;
3052 const u8 *supported_selectors;
3053 u8 supported_selectors_len;
3054 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
3055 const u8 *key;
3056 u8 key_len;
3057 s8 key_idx;
3058 const u8 *auth_data;
3059 size_t auth_data_len;
3060 s8 link_id;
3061 const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
3062 };
3063
3064 /**
3065 * struct cfg80211_assoc_link - per-link information for MLO association
3066 * @bss: the BSS pointer, see also &struct cfg80211_assoc_request::bss;
3067 * if this is %NULL for a link, that link is not requested
3068 * @elems: extra elements for the per-STA profile for this link
3069 * @elems_len: length of the elements
3070 * @disabled: If set this link should be included during association etc. but it
3071 * should not be used until enabled by the AP MLD.
3072 * @error: per-link error code, must be <= 0. If there is an error, then the
3073 * operation as a whole must fail.
3074 */
3075 struct cfg80211_assoc_link {
3076 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3077 const u8 *elems;
3078 size_t elems_len;
3079 bool disabled;
3080 int error;
3081 };
3082
3083 /**
3084 * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association.
3085 *
3086 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT: Disable HT (802.11n)
3087 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT: Disable VHT
3088 * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association
3089 * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external
3090 * authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to
3091 * userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect()
3092 * request (connect callback).
3093 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE: Disable HE
3094 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT: Disable EHT
3095 * @CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT: Userspace indicates support for handling MLD links.
3096 * Drivers shall disable MLO features for the current association if this
3097 * flag is not set.
3098 * @ASSOC_REQ_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs will be used on this connection (if any)
3099 */
3100 enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags {
3101 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT = BIT(0),
3102 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT = BIT(1),
3103 ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM = BIT(2),
3104 CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(3),
3105 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE = BIT(4),
3106 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT = BIT(5),
3107 CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT = BIT(6),
3108 ASSOC_REQ_SPP_AMSDU = BIT(7),
3109 };
3110
3111 /**
3112 * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data
3113 *
3114 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3115 * (re)association.
3116 * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is
3117 * given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc()
3118 * or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new
3119 * association requests while already associating must be rejected.
3120 * This also applies to the @links.bss parameter, which is used instead
3121 * of this one (it is %NULL) for MLO associations.
3122 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL
3123 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3124 * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association
3125 * @crypto: crypto settings
3126 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
3127 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
3128 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
3129 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
3130 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
3131 * frame.
3132 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
3133 * @supported_selectors: supported selectors in IEEE 802.11 format
3134 * (or %NULL for no change).
3135 * If %NULL, then support for SAE_H2E should be assumed.
3136 * @supported_selectors_len: Length of supported_selectors in octets.
3137 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask
3138 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored.
3139 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3140 * @vht_capa: VHT capability override
3141 * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use
3142 * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or
3143 * %NULL if FILS is not used.
3144 * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets
3145 * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association
3146 * Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts
3147 * with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
3148 * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override
3149 * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask
3150 * @links: per-link information for MLO connections
3151 * @link_id: >= 0 for MLO connections, where links are given, and indicates
3152 * the link on which the association request should be sent
3153 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of MLO association request,
3154 * valid iff @link_id >= 0
3155 */
3156 struct cfg80211_assoc_request {
3157 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3158 const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid;
3159 size_t ie_len;
3160 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
3161 bool use_mfp;
3162 u32 flags;
3163 const u8 *supported_selectors;
3164 u8 supported_selectors_len;
3165 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3166 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3167 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask;
3168 const u8 *fils_kek;
3169 size_t fils_kek_len;
3170 const u8 *fils_nonces;
3171 struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask;
3172 struct cfg80211_assoc_link links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
3173 const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
3174 s8 link_id;
3175 };
3176
3177 /**
3178 * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data
3179 *
3180 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3181 * deauthentication.
3182 *
3183 * @bssid: the BSSID or AP MLD address to deauthenticate from
3184 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL
3185 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3186 * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication
3187 * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and
3188 * do not set a deauth frame
3189 */
3190 struct cfg80211_deauth_request {
3191 const u8 *bssid;
3192 const u8 *ie;
3193 size_t ie_len;
3194 u16 reason_code;
3195 bool local_state_change;
3196 };
3197
3198 /**
3199 * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data
3200 *
3201 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3202 * disassociation.
3203 *
3204 * @ap_addr: the BSSID or AP MLD address to disassociate from
3205 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL
3206 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3207 * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation
3208 * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no
3209 * Disassociation frame is to be transmitted.
3210 */
3211 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request {
3212 const u8 *ap_addr;
3213 const u8 *ie;
3214 size_t ie_len;
3215 u16 reason_code;
3216 bool local_state_change;
3217 };
3218
3219 /**
3220 * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters
3221 *
3222 * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss()
3223 * method.
3224 *
3225 * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null.
3226 * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero.
3227 * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not
3228 * search for IBSSs with a different BSSID.
3229 * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found
3230 * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for
3231 * IBSSs to join on other channels.
3232 * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon
3233 * @ie_len: length of that
3234 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
3235 * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured
3236 * after joining
3237 * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
3238 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
3239 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
3240 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
3241 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
3242 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
3243 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
3244 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
3245 * to operate on DFS channels.
3246 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS
3247 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
3248 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask
3249 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored.
3250 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3251 * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
3252 * CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
3253 * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
3254 */
3255 struct cfg80211_ibss_params {
3256 const u8 *ssid;
3257 const u8 *bssid;
3258 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
3259 const u8 *ie;
3260 u8 ssid_len, ie_len;
3261 u16 beacon_interval;
3262 u32 basic_rates;
3263 bool channel_fixed;
3264 bool privacy;
3265 bool control_port;
3266 bool control_port_over_nl80211;
3267 bool userspace_handles_dfs;
3268 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
3269 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3270 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3271 struct key_params *wep_keys;
3272 int wep_tx_key;
3273 };
3274
3275 /**
3276 * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection.
3277 *
3278 * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour.
3279 * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour.
3280 * @param.band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF.
3281 * @param.adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST.
3282 */
3283 struct cfg80211_bss_selection {
3284 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour;
3285 union {
3286 enum nl80211_band band_pref;
3287 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust;
3288 } param;
3289 };
3290
3291 /**
3292 * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters
3293 *
3294 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3295 * authentication and association.
3296 *
3297 * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based
3298 * on scan results)
3299 * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or
3300 * %NULL if not specified
3301 * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan
3302 * results)
3303 * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or
3304 * %NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is
3305 * allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS
3306 * to use.
3307 * @ssid: SSID
3308 * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets
3309 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
3310 * @ie: IEs for association request
3311 * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets
3312 * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used
3313 * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used
3314 * @crypto: crypto settings
3315 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
3316 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
3317 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
3318 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
3319 * @bg_scan_period: Background scan period in seconds
3320 * or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used.
3321 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask
3322 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored.
3323 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3324 * @vht_capa: VHT Capability overrides
3325 * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used.
3326 * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG
3327 * networks.
3328 * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection.
3329 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
3330 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
3331 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
3332 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
3333 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
3334 * frame.
3335 * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the
3336 * NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped
3337 * data IE.
3338 * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets.
3339 * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or
3340 * %NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and
3341 * is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
3342 * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets.
3343 * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP
3344 * messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
3345 * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional
3346 * keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified.
3347 * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets.
3348 * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver
3349 * offload of 4-way handshake.
3350 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels.
3351 * This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver
3352 * to choose from, based on BSS configuration.
3353 */
3354 struct cfg80211_connect_params {
3355 struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
3356 struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint;
3357 const u8 *bssid;
3358 const u8 *bssid_hint;
3359 const u8 *ssid;
3360 size_t ssid_len;
3361 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
3362 const u8 *ie;
3363 size_t ie_len;
3364 bool privacy;
3365 enum nl80211_mfp mfp;
3366 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
3367 const u8 *key;
3368 u8 key_len, key_idx;
3369 u32 flags;
3370 int bg_scan_period;
3371 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3372 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3373 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa;
3374 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask;
3375 bool pbss;
3376 struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select;
3377 const u8 *prev_bssid;
3378 const u8 *fils_erp_username;
3379 size_t fils_erp_username_len;
3380 const u8 *fils_erp_realm;
3381 size_t fils_erp_realm_len;
3382 u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num;
3383 const u8 *fils_erp_rrk;
3384 size_t fils_erp_rrk_len;
3385 bool want_1x;
3386 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
3387 };
3388
3389 /**
3390 * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated
3391 *
3392 * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that
3393 * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call.
3394 *
3395 * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated
3396 * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm,
3397 * username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated
3398 * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated
3399 */
3400 enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed {
3401 UPDATE_ASSOC_IES = BIT(0),
3402 UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO = BIT(1),
3403 UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE = BIT(2),
3404 };
3405
3406 /**
3407 * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values
3408 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed
3409 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed
3410 * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed
3411 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed
3412 * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed
3413 * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled
3414 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed
3415 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed
3416 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum
3417 */
3418 enum wiphy_params_flags {
3419 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT = BIT(0),
3420 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG = BIT(1),
3421 WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD = BIT(2),
3422 WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD = BIT(3),
3423 WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS = BIT(4),
3424 WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK = BIT(5),
3425 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT = BIT(6),
3426 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT = BIT(7),
3427 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM = BIT(8),
3428 };
3429
3430 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT 256
3431
3432 /* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */
3433 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L 5000
3434 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H 12000
3435
3436 /* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */
3437 #define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD 24000
3438
3439 /**
3440 * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association
3441 *
3442 * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA
3443 * caching.
3444 *
3445 * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL).
3446 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3447 * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key
3448 * derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL.
3449 * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on
3450 * the hash algorithm used to generate this.
3451 * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS
3452 * cache identifier (may be %NULL).
3453 * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets.
3454 * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the
3455 * scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be
3456 * %NULL).
3457 * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds
3458 * (dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified.
3459 * The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after
3460 * expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on
3461 * expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK
3462 * used for it expires.
3463 * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of
3464 * PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified.
3465 * Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using
3466 * this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this
3467 * threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires.
3468 */
3469 struct cfg80211_pmksa {
3470 const u8 *bssid;
3471 const u8 *pmkid;
3472 const u8 *pmk;
3473 size_t pmk_len;
3474 const u8 *ssid;
3475 size_t ssid_len;
3476 const u8 *cache_id;
3477 u32 pmk_lifetime;
3478 u8 pmk_reauth_threshold;
3479 };
3480
3481 /**
3482 * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern
3483 * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes,
3484 * one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211
3485 * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1
3486 * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes)
3487 * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes)
3488 *
3489 * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of
3490 * memory, free @mask only!
3491 */
3492 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern {
3493 const u8 *mask, *pattern;
3494 int pattern_len;
3495 int pkt_offset;
3496 };
3497
3498 /**
3499 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters
3500 *
3501 * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation
3502 * @src: source IP address
3503 * @dst: destination IP address
3504 * @dst_mac: destination MAC address
3505 * @src_port: source port
3506 * @dst_port: destination port
3507 * @payload_len: data payload length
3508 * @payload: data payload buffer
3509 * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration
3510 * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets
3511 * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length
3512 * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data
3513 * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask
3514 * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer
3515 * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration
3516 */
3517 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp {
3518 struct socket *sock;
3519 __be32 src, dst;
3520 u16 src_port, dst_port;
3521 u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN];
3522 int payload_len;
3523 const u8 *payload;
3524 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq;
3525 u32 data_interval;
3526 u32 wake_len;
3527 const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask;
3528 u32 tokens_size;
3529 /* must be last, variable member */
3530 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok;
3531 };
3532
3533 /**
3534 * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info
3535 *
3536 * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device.
3537 * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues
3538 * operating as normal during suspend
3539 * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected
3540 * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet
3541 * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern
3542 * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3543 * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure
3544 * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet
3545 * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake
3546 * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released
3547 * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h.
3548 * NULL if not configured.
3549 * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake.
3550 */
3551 struct cfg80211_wowlan {
3552 bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3553 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3554 rfkill_release;
3555 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3556 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp;
3557 int n_patterns;
3558 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config;
3559 };
3560
3561 /**
3562 * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters
3563 *
3564 * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device.
3565 * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs.
3566 * @condition: condition for packet coalescence.
3567 * see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
3568 * @patterns: array of packet patterns
3569 * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3570 */
3571 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules {
3572 int delay;
3573 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition;
3574 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3575 int n_patterns;
3576 };
3577
3578 /**
3579 * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings
3580 *
3581 * This structure defines coalescing settings.
3582 * @rules: array of coalesce rules
3583 * @n_rules: number of rules
3584 */
3585 struct cfg80211_coalesce {
3586 int n_rules;
3587 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules rules[] __counted_by(n_rules);
3588 };
3589
3590 /**
3591 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match
3592 *
3593 * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up
3594 * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred. This
3595 * value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels.
3596 * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match
3597 * occurred (in MHz)
3598 */
3599 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match {
3600 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3601 int n_channels;
3602 u32 channels[] __counted_by(n_channels);
3603 };
3604
3605 /**
3606 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information
3607 *
3608 * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in
3609 * @matches. This value may be zero if the driver can't provide
3610 * match information.
3611 * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about
3612 * the matches that triggered the wake up.
3613 */
3614 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info {
3615 int n_matches;
3616 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[] __counted_by(n_matches);
3617 };
3618
3619 /**
3620 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report
3621 * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected
3622 * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet
3623 * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure
3624 * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet
3625 * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake
3626 * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released
3627 * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern
3628 * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data
3629 * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length
3630 * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any.
3631 * @packet_80211: For pattern match, magic packet and other data
3632 * frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for
3633 * disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which
3634 * it is.
3635 * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received
3636 * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish
3637 * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens
3638 * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect
3639 * @unprot_deauth_disassoc: woke up due to unprotected deauth or
3640 * disassoc frame (in MFP).
3641 */
3642 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup {
3643 bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3644 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3645 rfkill_release, packet_80211,
3646 tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens,
3647 unprot_deauth_disassoc;
3648 s32 pattern_idx;
3649 u32 packet_present_len, packet_len;
3650 const void *packet;
3651 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect;
3652 };
3653
3654 /**
3655 * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data
3656 * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes)
3657 * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes)
3658 * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes)
3659 * @kek_len: length of kek
3660 * @kck_len: length of kck
3661 * @akm: akm (oui, id)
3662 */
3663 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data {
3664 const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr;
3665 u32 akm;
3666 u8 kek_len, kck_len;
3667 };
3668
3669 /**
3670 * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information
3671 *
3672 * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE
3673 *
3674 * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value
3675 * @ie: Fast Transition IEs
3676 * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets
3677 */
3678 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params {
3679 u16 md;
3680 const u8 *ie;
3681 size_t ie_len;
3682 };
3683
3684 /**
3685 * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters
3686 *
3687 * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame
3688 *
3689 * @chan: channel to use
3690 * @offchan: indicates whether off channel operation is required
3691 * @wait: duration for ROC
3692 * @buf: buffer to transmit
3693 * @len: buffer length
3694 * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame
3695 * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack
3696 * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array
3697 * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame
3698 * @link_id: for MLO, the link ID to transmit on, -1 if not given; note
3699 * that the link ID isn't validated (much), it's in range but the
3700 * link might not exist (or be used by the receiver STA)
3701 */
3702 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params {
3703 struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
3704 bool offchan;
3705 unsigned int wait;
3706 const u8 *buf;
3707 size_t len;
3708 bool no_cck;
3709 bool dont_wait_for_ack;
3710 int n_csa_offsets;
3711 const u16 *csa_offsets;
3712 int link_id;
3713 };
3714
3715 /**
3716 * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception
3717 *
3718 * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition
3719 * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs
3720 */
3721 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception {
3722 u8 dscp;
3723 u8 up;
3724 };
3725
3726 /**
3727 * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority
3728 *
3729 * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3730 * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3731 */
3732 struct cfg80211_dscp_range {
3733 u8 low;
3734 u8 high;
3735 };
3736
3737 /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */
3738 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX 21
3739 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN 16
3740 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \
3741 (IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX)
3742
3743 /**
3744 * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information
3745 *
3746 * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values
3747 *
3748 * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21)
3749 * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from
3750 * the user priority DSCP range definition
3751 * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority
3752 */
3753 struct cfg80211_qos_map {
3754 u8 num_des;
3755 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX];
3756 struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8];
3757 };
3758
3759 /**
3760 * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration
3761 *
3762 * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters
3763 *
3764 * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255)
3765 * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.
3766 * For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
3767 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
3768 */
3769 struct cfg80211_nan_conf {
3770 u8 master_pref;
3771 u8 bands;
3772 };
3773
3774 /**
3775 * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN
3776 * configuration
3777 *
3778 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference
3779 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands
3780 */
3781 enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes {
3782 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0),
3783 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1),
3784 };
3785
3786 /**
3787 * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter
3788 *
3789 * @filter: the content of the filter
3790 * @len: the length of the filter
3791 */
3792 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter {
3793 const u8 *filter;
3794 u8 len;
3795 };
3796
3797 /**
3798 * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function
3799 *
3800 * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type
3801 * @service_id: the service ID of the function
3802 * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type
3803 * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is
3804 * implementation specific.
3805 * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted
3806 * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active
3807 * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up
3808 * @followup_reqid: the requester instance ID for follow up
3809 * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up
3810 * @ttl: time to live counter in DW.
3811 * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info
3812 * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length
3813 * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive
3814 * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter
3815 * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length
3816 * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index
3817 * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses
3818 * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF
3819 * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter
3820 * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF.
3821 * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters.
3822 * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters.
3823 * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function.
3824 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier.
3825 */
3826 struct cfg80211_nan_func {
3827 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
3828 u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN];
3829 u8 publish_type;
3830 bool close_range;
3831 bool publish_bcast;
3832 bool subscribe_active;
3833 u8 followup_id;
3834 u8 followup_reqid;
3835 struct mac_address followup_dest;
3836 u32 ttl;
3837 const u8 *serv_spec_info;
3838 u8 serv_spec_info_len;
3839 bool srf_include;
3840 const u8 *srf_bf;
3841 u8 srf_bf_len;
3842 u8 srf_bf_idx;
3843 struct mac_address *srf_macs;
3844 int srf_num_macs;
3845 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters;
3846 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters;
3847 u8 num_tx_filters;
3848 u8 num_rx_filters;
3849 u8 instance_id;
3850 u64 cookie;
3851 };
3852
3853 /**
3854 * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration
3855 *
3856 * @aa: authenticator address
3857 * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes.
3858 * @pmk: the PMK material
3859 * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK
3860 * is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field
3861 * holds PMK-R0.
3862 */
3863 struct cfg80211_pmk_conf {
3864 const u8 *aa;
3865 u8 pmk_len;
3866 const u8 *pmk;
3867 const u8 *pmk_r0_name;
3868 };
3869
3870 /**
3871 * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication.
3872 *
3873 * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces.
3874 *
3875 * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant
3876 * for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space).
3877 * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has
3878 * to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and
3879 * authentication response command interface.
3880 * @ssid: SSID of the AP. Used by both the authentication request event and
3881 * authentication response command interface.
3882 * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the
3883 * authentication request event interface.
3884 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication,
3885 * use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you
3886 * the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication
3887 * response command interface (user space to driver).
3888 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3889 * @mld_addr: MLD address of the peer. Used by the authentication request event
3890 * interface. Driver indicates this to enable MLO during the authentication
3891 * offload to user space. Driver shall look at %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT
3892 * flag capability in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space
3893 * supports enabling MLO during the authentication offload.
3894 * User space should use the address of the interface (on which the
3895 * authentication request event reported) as self MLD address. User space
3896 * and driver should use MLD addresses in RA, TA and BSSID fields of
3897 * authentication frames sent or received via cfg80211. The driver
3898 * translates the MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link
3899 * chosen for the authentication.
3900 */
3901 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params {
3902 enum nl80211_external_auth_action action;
3903 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3904 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3905 unsigned int key_mgmt_suite;
3906 u16 status;
3907 const u8 *pmkid;
3908 u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3909 };
3910
3911 /**
3912 * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
3913 *
3914 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to
3915 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
3916 * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully
3917 * answered
3918 * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were
3919 * successfully answered
3920 * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions
3921 * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions
3922 * @non_asap_num: number of non-ASAP FTM sessions
3923 * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication
3924 * of how much time the responder was busy
3925 * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from
3926 * initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with
3927 * the responder
3928 * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks
3929 * for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot
3930 * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window
3931 */
3932 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats {
3933 u32 filled;
3934 u32 success_num;
3935 u32 partial_num;
3936 u32 failed_num;
3937 u32 asap_num;
3938 u32 non_asap_num;
3939 u64 total_duration_ms;
3940 u32 unknown_triggers_num;
3941 u32 reschedule_requests_num;
3942 u32 out_of_window_triggers_num;
3943 };
3944
3945 /**
3946 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result
3947 * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is
3948 * %NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise
3949 * reason than just "failure"
3950 * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index
3951 * in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported
3952 * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted
3953 * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked
3954 * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
3955 * fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible
3956 * by the responder
3957 * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated
3958 * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated
3959 * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated
3960 * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present)
3961 * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present)
3962 * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL)
3963 * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL)
3964 * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3965 * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3966 * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response
3967 * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame
3968 * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg)
3969 * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is
3970 * the square root of the variance)
3971 * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured
3972 * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured
3973 * (must have either this or @rtt_avg)
3974 * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance)
3975 * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread)
3976 * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid
3977 * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid
3978 * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid
3979 * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid
3980 * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid
3981 * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid
3982 * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid
3983 * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid
3984 * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid
3985 * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid
3986 * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid
3987 * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid
3988 */
3989 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result {
3990 const u8 *lci;
3991 const u8 *civicloc;
3992 unsigned int lci_len;
3993 unsigned int civicloc_len;
3994 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason;
3995 u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes;
3996 s16 burst_index;
3997 u8 busy_retry_time;
3998 u8 num_bursts_exp;
3999 u8 burst_duration;
4000 u8 ftms_per_burst;
4001 s32 rssi_avg;
4002 s32 rssi_spread;
4003 struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate;
4004 s64 rtt_avg;
4005 s64 rtt_variance;
4006 s64 rtt_spread;
4007 s64 dist_avg;
4008 s64 dist_variance;
4009 s64 dist_spread;
4010
4011 u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1,
4012 num_ftmr_successes_valid:1,
4013 rssi_avg_valid:1,
4014 rssi_spread_valid:1,
4015 tx_rate_valid:1,
4016 rx_rate_valid:1,
4017 rtt_avg_valid:1,
4018 rtt_variance_valid:1,
4019 rtt_spread_valid:1,
4020 dist_avg_valid:1,
4021 dist_variance_valid:1,
4022 dist_spread_valid:1;
4023 };
4024
4025 /**
4026 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result
4027 * @addr: address of the peer
4028 * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the
4029 * measurement was made)
4030 * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time
4031 * @status: status of the measurement
4032 * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not
4033 * reporting partial results always set this flag
4034 * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid
4035 * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting
4036 * one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and
4037 * they're all aggregated for userspace.
4038 * @ftm: FTM result
4039 */
4040 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result {
4041 u64 host_time, ap_tsf;
4042 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status;
4043
4044 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
4045
4046 u8 final:1,
4047 ap_tsf_valid:1;
4048
4049 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type;
4050
4051 union {
4052 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm;
4053 };
4054 };
4055
4056 /**
4057 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data
4058 * @requested: indicates FTM is requested
4059 * @preamble: frame preamble to use
4060 * @burst_period: burst period to use
4061 * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode
4062 * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent
4063 * @burst_duration: burst duration
4064 * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst
4065 * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request
4066 * @request_lci: request LCI information
4067 * @request_civicloc: request civic location information
4068 * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement
4069 * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
4070 * EDCA based ranging will be used.
4071 * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement
4072 * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
4073 * EDCA based ranging will be used.
4074 * @lmr_feedback: negotiate for I2R LMR feedback. Only valid if either
4075 * @trigger_based or @non_trigger_based is set.
4076 * @bss_color: the bss color of the responder. Optional. Set to zero to
4077 * indicate the driver should set the BSS color. Only valid if
4078 * @non_trigger_based or @trigger_based is set.
4079 *
4080 * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation.
4081 */
4082 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer {
4083 enum nl80211_preamble preamble;
4084 u16 burst_period;
4085 u8 requested:1,
4086 asap:1,
4087 request_lci:1,
4088 request_civicloc:1,
4089 trigger_based:1,
4090 non_trigger_based:1,
4091 lmr_feedback:1;
4092 u8 num_bursts_exp;
4093 u8 burst_duration;
4094 u8 ftms_per_burst;
4095 u8 ftmr_retries;
4096 u8 bss_color;
4097 };
4098
4099 /**
4100 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request
4101 * @addr: MAC address
4102 * @chandef: channel to use
4103 * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF
4104 * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer
4105 */
4106 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer {
4107 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
4108 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
4109 u8 report_ap_tsf:1;
4110 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm;
4111 };
4112
4113 /**
4114 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request
4115 * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211
4116 * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211
4117 * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting,
4118 * not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211
4119 * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request
4120 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that
4121 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
4122 * be taken from the @mac_addr
4123 * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request
4124 * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if
4125 * zero it means there's no timeout
4126 * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with
4127 * @peers: per-peer measurement request data
4128 */
4129 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request {
4130 u64 cookie;
4131 void *drv_data;
4132 u32 n_peers;
4133 u32 nl_portid;
4134
4135 u32 timeout;
4136
4137 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4138 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4139
4140 struct list_head list;
4141
4142 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[] __counted_by(n_peers);
4143 };
4144
4145 /**
4146 * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information
4147 *
4148 * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE
4149 * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space.
4150 *
4151 * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces.
4152 *
4153 * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing
4154 * has to be done.
4155 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info
4156 * processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space
4157 * cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for
4158 * OWE update request command interface (user space to driver).
4159 * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are
4160 * the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and
4161 * the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface.
4162 * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets.
4163 * @assoc_link_id: MLO link ID of the AP, with which (re)association requested
4164 * by peer. This will be filled by driver for both MLO and non-MLO station
4165 * connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD. For non-MLD AP mode, it
4166 * will be -1. Used only with OWE update event (driver to user space).
4167 * @peer_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the peer. For non-MLO
4168 * connection, it will be all zeros. This is applicable only when
4169 * @assoc_link_id is not -1, i.e., the AP affiliated with an MLD. Used only
4170 * with OWE update event (driver to user space).
4171 */
4172 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info {
4173 u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4174 u16 status;
4175 const u8 *ie;
4176 size_t ie_len;
4177 int assoc_link_id;
4178 u8 peer_mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4179 };
4180
4181 /**
4182 * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data
4183 * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
4184 * for the entire device
4185 * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
4186 * for the given interface
4187 * @global_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes
4188 * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface
4189 * for these subtypes
4190 */
4191 struct mgmt_frame_regs {
4192 u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes;
4193 u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes;
4194 };
4195
4196 /**
4197 * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration
4198 *
4199 * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks
4200 * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces.
4201 *
4202 * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0
4203 * on success or a negative error code.
4204 *
4205 * All operations are invoked with the wiphy mutex held. The RTNL may be
4206 * held in addition (due to wireless extensions) but this cannot be relied
4207 * upon except in cases where documented below. Note that due to ordering,
4208 * the RTNL also cannot be acquired in any handlers.
4209 *
4210 * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will
4211 * be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are
4212 * configured for the device.
4213 * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed
4214 * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback
4215 * to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from
4216 * the device.
4217 *
4218 * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name,
4219 * must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create
4220 * the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct
4221 * wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must
4222 * also set the address member in the wdev.
4223 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4224 *
4225 * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface
4226 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4227 *
4228 * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface,
4229 * keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated.
4230 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4231 *
4232 * @add_intf_link: Add a new MLO link to the given interface. Note that
4233 * the wdev->link[] data structure has been updated, so the new link
4234 * address is available.
4235 * @del_intf_link: Remove an MLO link from the given interface.
4236 *
4237 * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL
4238 * when adding a group key. @link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection.
4239 * For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for
4240 * pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key.
4241 *
4242 * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters.
4243 * @mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group
4244 * key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid
4245 * after it returns. This function should return an error if it is
4246 * not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist.
4247 * @link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection,
4248 * @link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr
4249 * will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key.
4250 *
4251 * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key)
4252 * and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist. @link_id will
4253 * be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0
4254 * for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD
4255 * address for MLO pairwise key.
4256 *
4257 * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface. @link_id will be >= 0
4258 * for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4259 *
4260 * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface.
4261 * @link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4262 *
4263 * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface.
4264 * @link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4265 *
4266 * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver
4267 *
4268 * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters.
4269 * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode
4270 * interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started.
4271 * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing.
4272 *
4273 * @add_station: Add a new station.
4274 * @del_station: Remove a station
4275 * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much
4276 * validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags
4277 * might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check
4278 * them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call
4279 * cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information.
4280 * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac
4281 * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4282 *
4283 * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path
4284 * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path
4285 * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path
4286 * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters
4287 * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4288 * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters
4289 * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4290 * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters
4291 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4292 * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network
4293 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4294 *
4295 * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration
4296 *
4297 * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh.
4298 * The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to
4299 * set, and which to leave alone.
4300 *
4301 * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS.
4302 *
4303 * @inform_bss: Called by cfg80211 while being informed about new BSS data
4304 * for every BSS found within the reported data or frame. This is called
4305 * from within the cfg8011 inform_bss handlers while holding the bss_lock.
4306 * The data parameter is passed through from drv_data inside
4307 * struct cfg80211_inform_bss.
4308 * The new IE data for the BSS is explicitly passed.
4309 *
4310 * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters
4311 *
4312 * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas,
4313 * as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to
4314 * join the mesh instead.
4315 *
4316 * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other
4317 * interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration.
4318 * If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should
4319 * be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active.
4320 *
4321 * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given
4322 * the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done().
4323 * For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside
4324 * the scan/scan_done bracket too.
4325 * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall
4326 * indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done().
4327 *
4328 * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer
4329 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4330 * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer
4331 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4332 * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer
4333 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4334 * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer
4335 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4336 *
4337 * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected,
4338 * call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code
4339 * %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call
4340 * cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code
4341 * from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code
4342 * was received.
4343 * The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the
4344 * other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated
4345 * by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches
4346 * the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request
4347 * frame instead of Association Request frame.
4348 * The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a
4349 * specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid
4350 * parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an
4351 * indication of requesting reassociation.
4352 * In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming
4353 * cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to
4354 * cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4355 * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a
4356 * BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for
4357 * subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the
4358 * Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not
4359 * request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current
4360 * BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in
4361 * changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed.
4362 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4363 * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if
4364 * connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in
4365 * case connection was already established (invoked with the
4366 * wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout().
4367 *
4368 * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call
4369 * cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due
4370 * to a merge.
4371 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4372 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS.
4373 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4374 *
4375 * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or
4376 * MESH mode)
4377 *
4378 * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed;
4379 * @changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values
4380 * have changed. The actual parameter values are available in
4381 * struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed.
4382 *
4383 * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters,
4384 * the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The
4385 * wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will
4386 * always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power
4387 * (as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.)
4388 * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable;
4389 * return 0 if successful
4390 *
4391 * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting
4392 * functions to adjust rfkill hw state
4393 *
4394 * @dump_survey: get site survey information.
4395 *
4396 * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified
4397 * channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel
4398 * operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is
4399 * ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event
4400 * notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel().
4401 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation.
4402 * This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on
4403 * the duration value.
4404 * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame.
4405 * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management
4406 * frame on another channel
4407 *
4408 * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL
4409 * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be
4410 * used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally,
4411 * return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the
4412 * dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data
4413 * was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present
4414 * and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA.
4415 *
4416 * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration
4417 *
4418 * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac
4419 * devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association
4420 * RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs.
4421 * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID.
4422 * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs.
4423 * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1
4424 * allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value.
4425 * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold.
4426 * After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating
4427 * the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may
4428 * need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being
4429 * disabled.)
4430 * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the
4431 * connection quality monitor. An event is to be sent only when the
4432 * signal level is found to be outside the two values. The driver should
4433 * set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented.
4434 * If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config.
4435 * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error
4436 * thresholds.
4437 * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan.
4438 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with
4439 * given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready
4440 * for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be
4441 * called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case.
4442 * The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested
4443 * stop (when this method returns 0).
4444 *
4445 * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame
4446 * registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep.
4447 *
4448 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4449 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4450 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4451 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4452 *
4453 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4454 *
4455 * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame.
4456 * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup).
4457 *
4458 * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it
4459 * later passes to cfg80211_probe_status().
4460 *
4461 * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs.
4462 *
4463 * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface.
4464 * For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single
4465 * current monitoring channel.
4466 *
4467 * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device.
4468 * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device.
4469 *
4470 * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode.
4471 * Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations
4472 * and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver
4473 * this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL
4474 * when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which
4475 * advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback.
4476 *
4477 * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver.
4478 *
4479 * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC
4480 * was finished on another phy.
4481 *
4482 * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the
4483 * driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be
4484 * used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames.
4485 *
4486 * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability
4487 * for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the
4488 * driver can take the most appropriate actions.
4489 * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link
4490 * reliability. This operation can not fail.
4491 * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters.
4492 *
4493 * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is
4494 * responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is
4495 * inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later
4496 * with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept
4497 * everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them
4498 * as soon as possible.
4499 *
4500 * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver
4501 *
4502 * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the
4503 * given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width
4504 * changes during the lifetime of the BSS.
4505 *
4506 * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device
4507 * with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by
4508 * userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into
4509 * account.
4510 * If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure
4511 * the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return
4512 * success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake
4513 * with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later
4514 * rejected)
4515 * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS
4516 *
4517 * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters
4518 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4519 * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network
4520 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4521 *
4522 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4523 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4524 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP.
4525 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4526 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4527 * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface.
4528 * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface.
4529 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure.
4530 * On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and
4531 * it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver
4532 * should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling
4533 * cfg80211_free_nan_func().
4534 * On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the
4535 * provided @nan_func.
4536 * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function.
4537 * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must
4538 * be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes);
4539 * All other parameters must be ignored.
4540 *
4541 * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS
4542 *
4543 * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this
4544 * function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise.
4545 *
4546 * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake.
4547 * If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect
4548 * upon which the driver should clear it.
4549 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4550 * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator.
4551 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4552 *
4553 * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from
4554 * user space
4555 *
4556 * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL). The noencrypt parameter
4557 * tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted.
4558 *
4559 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4560 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4561 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM)
4562 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement
4563 *
4564 * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME
4565 * but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated
4566 * DH IE through this interface.
4567 *
4568 * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame
4569 * and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm.
4570 * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific
4571 * This callback may sleep.
4572 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the
4573 * given TIDs. This callback may sleep.
4574 *
4575 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4576 *
4577 * @color_change: Initiate a color change.
4578 *
4579 * @set_fils_aad: Set FILS AAD data to the AP driver so that the driver can use
4580 * those to decrypt (Re)Association Request and encrypt (Re)Association
4581 * Response frame.
4582 *
4583 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4584 * radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4585 * or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4586 * Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4587 * switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4588 * radar channel.
4589 * The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4590 * disable background CAC/radar detection.
4591 * @add_link_station: Add a link to a station.
4592 * @mod_link_station: Modify a link of a station.
4593 * @del_link_station: Remove a link of a station.
4594 *
4595 * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames.
4596 * @set_ttlm: set the TID to link mapping.
4597 * @set_epcs: Enable/Disable EPCS for station mode.
4598 * @get_radio_mask: get bitmask of radios in use.
4599 * (invoked with the wiphy mutex held)
4600 * @assoc_ml_reconf: Request a non-AP MLO connection to perform ML
4601 * reconfiguration, i.e., add and/or remove links to/from the
4602 * association using ML reconfiguration action frames. Successfully added
4603 * links will be added to the set of valid links. Successfully removed
4604 * links will be removed from the set of valid links. The driver must
4605 * indicate removed links by calling cfg80211_links_removed() and added
4606 * links by calling cfg80211_mlo_reconf_add_done(). When calling
4607 * cfg80211_mlo_reconf_add_done() the bss pointer must be given for each
4608 * link for which MLO reconfiguration 'add' operation was requested.
4609 */
4610 struct cfg80211_ops {
4611 int (*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow);
4612 int (*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4613 void (*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled);
4614
4615 struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4616 const char *name,
4617 unsigned char name_assign_type,
4618 enum nl80211_iftype type,
4619 struct vif_params *params);
4620 int (*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4621 struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4622 int (*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4623 struct net_device *dev,
4624 enum nl80211_iftype type,
4625 struct vif_params *params);
4626
4627 int (*add_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4628 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4629 unsigned int link_id);
4630 void (*del_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4631 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4632 unsigned int link_id);
4633
4634 int (*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4635 int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4636 const u8 *mac_addr, struct key_params *params);
4637 int (*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4638 int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4639 const u8 *mac_addr, void *cookie,
4640 void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*));
4641 int (*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4642 int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4643 const u8 *mac_addr);
4644 int (*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4645 struct net_device *netdev, int link_id,
4646 u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast);
4647 int (*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4648 struct net_device *netdev, int link_id,
4649 u8 key_index);
4650 int (*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4651 struct net_device *netdev,
4652 int link_id,
4653 u8 key_index);
4654
4655 int (*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4656 struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings);
4657 int (*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4658 struct cfg80211_ap_update *info);
4659 int (*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4660 unsigned int link_id);
4661
4662
4663 int (*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4664 const u8 *mac,
4665 struct station_parameters *params);
4666 int (*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4667 struct station_del_parameters *params);
4668 int (*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4669 const u8 *mac,
4670 struct station_parameters *params);
4671 int (*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4672 const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4673 int (*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4674 int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4675
4676 int (*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4677 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4678 int (*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4679 const u8 *dst);
4680 int (*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4681 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4682 int (*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4683 u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4684 int (*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4685 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop,
4686 struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4687 int (*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4688 u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4689 int (*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4690 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp,
4691 struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4692 int (*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4693 struct net_device *dev,
4694 struct mesh_config *conf);
4695 int (*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4696 struct net_device *dev, u32 mask,
4697 const struct mesh_config *nconf);
4698 int (*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4699 const struct mesh_config *conf,
4700 const struct mesh_setup *setup);
4701 int (*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4702
4703 int (*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4704 struct ocb_setup *setup);
4705 int (*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4706
4707 int (*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4708 struct bss_parameters *params);
4709
4710 void (*inform_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
4711 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies *ies, void *data);
4712
4713 int (*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4714 struct ieee80211_txq_params *params);
4715
4716 int (*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4717 struct net_device *dev,
4718 struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
4719
4720 int (*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4721 struct net_device *dev,
4722 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4723
4724 int (*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4725 struct cfg80211_scan_request *request);
4726 void (*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4727
4728 int (*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4729 struct cfg80211_auth_request *req);
4730 int (*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4731 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req);
4732 int (*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4733 struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req);
4734 int (*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4735 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req);
4736
4737 int (*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4738 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme);
4739 int (*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4740 struct net_device *dev,
4741 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme,
4742 u32 changed);
4743 int (*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4744 u16 reason_code);
4745
4746 int (*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4747 struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params);
4748 int (*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4749
4750 int (*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4751 int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]);
4752
4753 int (*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed);
4754
4755 int (*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4756 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm);
4757 int (*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4758 unsigned int link_id, int *dbm);
4759
4760 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4761
4762 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4763 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4764 void *data, int len);
4765 int (*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb,
4766 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4767 void *data, int len);
4768 #endif
4769
4770 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4771 struct net_device *dev,
4772 unsigned int link_id,
4773 const u8 *peer,
4774 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4775
4776 int (*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4777 int idx, struct survey_info *info);
4778
4779 int (*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4780 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4781 int (*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4782 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4783 int (*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev);
4784
4785 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4786 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4787 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4788 unsigned int duration,
4789 u64 *cookie);
4790 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4791 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4792 u64 cookie);
4793
4794 int (*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4795 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params,
4796 u64 *cookie);
4797 int (*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4798 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4799 u64 cookie);
4800
4801 int (*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4802 bool enabled, int timeout);
4803
4804 int (*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4805 struct net_device *dev,
4806 s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst);
4807
4808 int (*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4809 struct net_device *dev,
4810 s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high);
4811
4812 int (*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4813 struct net_device *dev,
4814 u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl);
4815
4816 void (*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4817 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4818 struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd);
4819
4820 int (*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4821 int (*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4822
4823 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4824 struct net_device *dev,
4825 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request);
4826 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4827 u64 reqid);
4828
4829 int (*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4830 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4831
4832 int (*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4833 const u8 *peer, int link_id,
4834 u8 action_code, u8 dialog_token, u16 status_code,
4835 u32 peer_capability, bool initiator,
4836 const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4837 int (*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4838 const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper);
4839
4840 int (*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4841 const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie);
4842
4843 int (*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4844 struct net_device *dev,
4845 u16 noack_map);
4846
4847 int (*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4848 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4849 unsigned int link_id,
4850 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4851
4852 int (*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4853 struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4854 void (*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4855 struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4856
4857 int (*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4858 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params);
4859
4860 int (*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4861 struct net_device *dev,
4862 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4863 u32 cac_time_ms, int link_id);
4864 void (*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4865 struct net_device *dev, unsigned int link_id);
4866 int (*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4867 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie);
4868 int (*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4869 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4870 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol,
4871 u16 duration);
4872 void (*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4873 struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4874 int (*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4875 struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce);
4876
4877 int (*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4878 struct net_device *dev,
4879 struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params);
4880
4881 int (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4882 struct net_device *dev,
4883 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
4884
4885 int (*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4886 unsigned int link_id,
4887 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4888
4889 int (*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4890 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio,
4891 u16 admitted_time);
4892 int (*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4893 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer);
4894
4895 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4896 struct net_device *dev,
4897 const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class,
4898 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4899 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4900 struct net_device *dev,
4901 const u8 *addr);
4902 int (*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4903 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4904 void (*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4905 int (*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4906 struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4907 void (*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4908 u64 cookie);
4909 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4910 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4911 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf,
4912 u32 changes);
4913
4914 int (*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4915 struct net_device *dev,
4916 const bool enabled);
4917
4918 int (*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4919 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4920 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats);
4921
4922 int (*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4923 const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf);
4924 int (*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4925 const u8 *aa);
4926 int (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4927 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params);
4928
4929 int (*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4930 struct net_device *dev,
4931 const u8 *buf, size_t len,
4932 const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto,
4933 const bool noencrypt, int link_id,
4934 u64 *cookie);
4935
4936 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4937 struct net_device *dev,
4938 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4939
4940 int (*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4941 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4942 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4943 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4944 int (*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4945 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info);
4946 int (*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4947 const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4948 int (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4949 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4950 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4951 const u8 *peer, u8 tids);
4952 int (*set_sar_specs)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4953 struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4954 int (*color_change)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4955 struct net_device *dev,
4956 struct cfg80211_color_change_settings *params);
4957 int (*set_fils_aad)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4958 struct cfg80211_fils_aad *fils_aad);
4959 int (*set_radar_background)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4960 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4961 int (*add_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4962 struct link_station_parameters *params);
4963 int (*mod_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4964 struct link_station_parameters *params);
4965 int (*del_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4966 struct link_station_del_parameters *params);
4967 int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4968 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4969 int (*set_ttlm)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4970 struct cfg80211_ttlm_params *params);
4971 u32 (*get_radio_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4972 int (*assoc_ml_reconf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4973 struct cfg80211_assoc_link *add_links,
4974 u16 rem_links);
4975 int (*set_epcs)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4976 bool val);
4977 };
4978
4979 /*
4980 * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures
4981 * and registration/helper functions
4982 */
4983
4984 /**
4985 * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags
4986 *
4987 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split
4988 * into two, first for legacy bands and second for 6 GHz.
4989 * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this
4990 * wiphy at all
4991 * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled
4992 * by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default
4993 * on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good
4994 * reason to override the default
4995 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station
4996 * on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of
4997 * supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype.
4998 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station
4999 * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the
5000 * control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the
5001 * control_port_no_encrypt flag.
5002 * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN.
5003 * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing
5004 * auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH.
5005 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the
5006 * firmware.
5007 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP.
5008 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation.
5009 * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z)
5010 * link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and
5011 * teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT
5012 * command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
5013 * used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation.
5014 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME
5015 * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes
5016 * when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling
5017 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon().
5018 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device
5019 * responds to probe-requests in hardware.
5020 * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX.
5021 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call.
5022 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels.
5023 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in
5024 * beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...).
5025 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys
5026 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO: This is a temporary flag gating the MLO APIs,
5027 * in order to not have them reachable in normal drivers, until we have
5028 * complete feature/interface combinations/etc. advertisement. No driver
5029 * should set this flag for now.
5030 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32: The device supports 32-byte KCK keys.
5031 * @WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER: The device could handle reg notify for
5032 * NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER.
5033 * @WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON: reg_call_notifier() is called if driver
5034 * set this flag to update channels on beacon hints.
5035 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_NSTR_NONPRIMARY: support connection to non-primary link
5036 * of an NSTR mobile AP MLD.
5037 * @WIPHY_FLAG_DISABLE_WEXT: disable wireless extensions for this device
5038 */
5039 enum wiphy_flags {
5040 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK = BIT(0),
5041 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO = BIT(1),
5042 WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ = BIT(2),
5043 WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK = BIT(3),
5044 WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT = BIT(4),
5045 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP = BIT(5),
5046 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION = BIT(6),
5047 WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL = BIT(7),
5048 WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN = BIT(8),
5049 WIPHY_FLAG_DISABLE_WEXT = BIT(9),
5050 WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH = BIT(10),
5051 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32 = BIT(11),
5052 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_NSTR_NONPRIMARY = BIT(12),
5053 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM = BIT(13),
5054 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD = BIT(14),
5055 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS = BIT(15),
5056 WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP = BIT(16),
5057 WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME = BIT(17),
5058 WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS = BIT(18),
5059 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD = BIT(19),
5060 WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX = BIT(20),
5061 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL = BIT(21),
5062 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ = BIT(22),
5063 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH = BIT(23),
5064 WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER = BIT(24),
5065 WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON = BIT(25),
5066 };
5067
5068 /**
5069 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types
5070 * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types
5071 * @types: interface types (bits)
5072 */
5073 struct ieee80211_iface_limit {
5074 u16 max;
5075 u16 types;
5076 };
5077
5078 /**
5079 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination
5080 *
5081 * With this structure the driver can describe which interface
5082 * combinations it supports concurrently. When set in a struct wiphy_radio,
5083 * the combinations refer to combinations of interfaces currently active on
5084 * that radio.
5085 *
5086 * Examples:
5087 *
5088 * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total:
5089 *
5090 * .. code-block:: c
5091 *
5092 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = {
5093 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
5094 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP), },
5095 * };
5096 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = {
5097 * .limits = limits1,
5098 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1),
5099 * .max_interfaces = 2,
5100 * .beacon_int_infra_match = true,
5101 * };
5102 *
5103 *
5104 * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total:
5105 *
5106 * .. code-block:: c
5107 *
5108 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = {
5109 * { .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) |
5110 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), },
5111 * };
5112 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = {
5113 * .limits = limits2,
5114 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2),
5115 * .max_interfaces = 8,
5116 * .num_different_channels = 1,
5117 * };
5118 *
5119 *
5120 * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total.
5121 *
5122 * This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections.
5123 *
5124 * .. code-block:: c
5125 *
5126 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = {
5127 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
5128 * { .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) |
5129 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), },
5130 * };
5131 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = {
5132 * .limits = limits3,
5133 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3),
5134 * .max_interfaces = 4,
5135 * .num_different_channels = 2,
5136 * };
5137 *
5138 */
5139 struct ieee80211_iface_combination {
5140 /**
5141 * @limits:
5142 * limits for the given interface types
5143 */
5144 const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits;
5145
5146 /**
5147 * @num_different_channels:
5148 * can use up to this many different channels
5149 */
5150 u32 num_different_channels;
5151
5152 /**
5153 * @max_interfaces:
5154 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group
5155 */
5156 u16 max_interfaces;
5157
5158 /**
5159 * @n_limits:
5160 * number of limitations
5161 */
5162 u8 n_limits;
5163
5164 /**
5165 * @beacon_int_infra_match:
5166 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure
5167 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases.
5168 */
5169 bool beacon_int_infra_match;
5170
5171 /**
5172 * @radar_detect_widths:
5173 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection
5174 */
5175 u8 radar_detect_widths;
5176
5177 /**
5178 * @radar_detect_regions:
5179 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection
5180 */
5181 u8 radar_detect_regions;
5182
5183 /**
5184 * @beacon_int_min_gcd:
5185 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals.
5186 *
5187 * = 0
5188 * all beacon intervals for different interface must be same.
5189 * > 0
5190 * any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND
5191 * GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this
5192 * combination must be greater or equal to this value.
5193 */
5194 u32 beacon_int_min_gcd;
5195 };
5196
5197 struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes {
5198 u16 tx, rx;
5199 };
5200
5201 /**
5202 * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags
5203 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any"
5204 * trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and
5205 * wakes up the host on any activity, for example a
5206 * received packet that passed filtering; note that the
5207 * packet should be preserved in that case
5208 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet
5209 * (see nl80211.h)
5210 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect
5211 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep
5212 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure
5213 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request
5214 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure
5215 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release
5216 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection
5217 */
5218 enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags {
5219 WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY = BIT(0),
5220 WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT = BIT(1),
5221 WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT = BIT(2),
5222 WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY = BIT(3),
5223 WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE = BIT(4),
5224 WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ = BIT(5),
5225 WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE = BIT(6),
5226 WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE = BIT(7),
5227 WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT = BIT(8),
5228 };
5229
5230 struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support {
5231 const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok;
5232 u32 data_payload_max;
5233 u32 data_interval_max;
5234 u32 wake_payload_max;
5235 bool seq;
5236 };
5237
5238 /**
5239 * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data
5240 * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags
5241 * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns
5242 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
5243 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
5244 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
5245 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5246 * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect,
5247 * similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for
5248 * scheduled scans.
5249 * See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more
5250 * details.
5251 * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information
5252 */
5253 struct wiphy_wowlan_support {
5254 u32 flags;
5255 int n_patterns;
5256 int pattern_max_len;
5257 int pattern_min_len;
5258 int max_pkt_offset;
5259 int max_nd_match_sets;
5260 const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp;
5261 };
5262
5263 /**
5264 * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data
5265 * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules
5266 * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
5267 * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule
5268 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
5269 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
5270 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
5271 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5272 */
5273 struct wiphy_coalesce_support {
5274 int n_rules;
5275 int max_delay;
5276 int n_patterns;
5277 int pattern_max_len;
5278 int pattern_min_len;
5279 int max_pkt_offset;
5280 };
5281
5282 /**
5283 * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands
5284 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev
5285 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev
5286 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running
5287 * (must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV)
5288 */
5289 enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags {
5290 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0),
5291 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1),
5292 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2),
5293 };
5294
5295 /**
5296 * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags
5297 *
5298 * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed
5299 * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed
5300 * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed
5301 *
5302 */
5303 enum wiphy_opmode_flag {
5304 STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0),
5305 STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED = BIT(1),
5306 STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED = BIT(2),
5307 };
5308
5309 /**
5310 * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information
5311 * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag
5312 * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station
5313 * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station
5314 * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station
5315 */
5316
5317 struct sta_opmode_info {
5318 u32 changed;
5319 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
5320 enum nl80211_chan_width bw;
5321 u8 rx_nss;
5322 };
5323
5324 #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA))
5325
5326 /**
5327 * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition
5328 * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211
5329 * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags
5330 * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the
5331 * flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data
5332 * pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all
5333 * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The
5334 * @storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple
5335 * dumpit calls.
5336 * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
5337 * Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the
5338 * attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command).
5339 * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy
5340 * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and
5341 * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others
5342 * are used with dump requests.
5343 */
5344 struct wiphy_vendor_command {
5345 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info;
5346 u32 flags;
5347 int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
5348 const void *data, int data_len);
5349 int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
5350 struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len,
5351 unsigned long *storage);
5352 const struct nla_policy *policy;
5353 unsigned int maxattr;
5354 };
5355
5356 /**
5357 * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type
5358 * @iftype: interface type
5359 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
5360 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the
5361 * 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are
5362 * in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std
5363 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields.
5364 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
5365 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
5366 * @eml_capabilities: EML capabilities (for MLO)
5367 * @mld_capa_and_ops: MLD capabilities and operations (for MLO)
5368 */
5369 struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab {
5370 enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
5371 const u8 *extended_capabilities;
5372 const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask;
5373 u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5374 u16 eml_capabilities;
5375 u16 mld_capa_and_ops;
5376 };
5377
5378 /**
5379 * cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa - lookup interface type extended capability
5380 * @wiphy: the wiphy to look up from
5381 * @type: the interface type to look up
5382 *
5383 * Return: The extended capability for the given interface @type, may be %NULL
5384 */
5385 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *
5386 cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype type);
5387
5388 /**
5389 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities
5390 * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement
5391 * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement
5392 * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement
5393 * @ftm: FTM measurement data
5394 * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported
5395 * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported
5396 * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported
5397 * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data
5398 * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data
5399 * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble)
5400 * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width)
5401 * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported
5402 * (set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily
5403 * forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick)
5404 * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if
5405 * not limited)
5406 * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported
5407 * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported
5408 */
5409 struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities {
5410 unsigned int max_peers;
5411 u8 report_ap_tsf:1,
5412 randomize_mac_addr:1;
5413
5414 struct {
5415 u32 preambles;
5416 u32 bandwidths;
5417 s8 max_bursts_exponent;
5418 u8 max_ftms_per_burst;
5419 u8 supported:1,
5420 asap:1,
5421 non_asap:1,
5422 request_lci:1,
5423 request_civicloc:1,
5424 trigger_based:1,
5425 non_trigger_based:1;
5426 } ftm;
5427 };
5428
5429 /**
5430 * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm
5431 * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the
5432 * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites.
5433 *
5434 * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types
5435 * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites
5436 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
5437 */
5438 struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites {
5439 u16 iftypes_mask;
5440 const u32 *akm_suites;
5441 int n_akm_suites;
5442 };
5443
5444 /**
5445 * struct wiphy_radio_freq_range - wiphy frequency range
5446 * @start_freq: start range edge frequency (kHz)
5447 * @end_freq: end range edge frequency (kHz)
5448 */
5449 struct wiphy_radio_freq_range {
5450 u32 start_freq;
5451 u32 end_freq;
5452 };
5453
5454
5455 /**
5456 * struct wiphy_radio - physical radio of a wiphy
5457 * This structure describes a physical radio belonging to a wiphy.
5458 * It is used to describe concurrent-channel capabilities. Only one channel
5459 * can be active on the radio described by struct wiphy_radio.
5460 *
5461 * @freq_range: frequency range that the radio can operate on.
5462 * @n_freq_range: number of elements in @freq_range
5463 *
5464 * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not
5465 * list single interface types.
5466 * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array.
5467 *
5468 * @antenna_mask: bitmask of antennas connected to this radio.
5469 */
5470 struct wiphy_radio {
5471 const struct wiphy_radio_freq_range *freq_range;
5472 int n_freq_range;
5473
5474 const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations;
5475 int n_iface_combinations;
5476
5477 u32 antenna_mask;
5478 };
5479
5480 #define CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS 0xffff
5481
5482 /**
5483 * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description
5484 * @mtx: mutex for the data (structures) of this device
5485 * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback,
5486 * note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory()
5487 * the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL
5488 * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via
5489 * the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver
5490 * on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future
5491 * regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers.
5492 * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss.
5493 * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites
5494 * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites
5495 * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if
5496 * the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in
5497 * iftype_akm_suites.
5498 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
5499 * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type.
5500 * Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot
5501 * overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all
5502 * instances of iftype_akm_suites).
5503 * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm
5504 * suites are specified separately.
5505 * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit)
5506 * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit)
5507 * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold);
5508 * -1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used
5509 * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled
5510 * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in
5511 * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device
5512 * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking,
5513 * set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last
5514 * four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual
5515 * variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with
5516 * interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up.
5517 * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses.
5518 * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer
5519 * to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used
5520 * by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to
5521 * all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle
5522 * the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses.
5523 * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against
5524 * unregister hardware
5525 * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>).
5526 * It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames
5527 * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in
5528 * /sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev()
5529 * (see below).
5530 * @wext: wireless extension handlers
5531 * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter)
5532 * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy,
5533 * must be set by driver
5534 * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not
5535 * list single interface types.
5536 * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array.
5537 * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not
5538 * subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW.
5539 * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags
5540 * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see
5541 * &enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags
5542 * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags.
5543 * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see
5544 * &enum nl80211_ext_feature_index.
5545 * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it,
5546 * this variable determines its size
5547 * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in
5548 * any given scan
5549 * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that
5550 * the device can run concurrently.
5551 * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan
5552 * for in any given scheduled scan
5553 * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle
5554 * when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not
5555 * supported.
5556 * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can
5557 * add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not
5558 * include fixed IEs like supported rates
5559 * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled
5560 * scans
5561 * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number
5562 * of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device.
5563 * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a
5564 * single scan plan supported by the device.
5565 * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single
5566 * scan plan supported by the device.
5567 * @coverage_class: current coverage class
5568 * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting
5569 * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting
5570 * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device
5571 * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary
5572 * wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers
5573 * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device
5574 *
5575 * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or
5576 * transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface
5577 * type
5578 *
5579 * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
5580 * configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
5581 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set.
5582 *
5583 * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
5584 * configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
5585 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set.
5586 *
5587 * @probe_resp_offload:
5588 * Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading.
5589 * See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid
5590 * when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set.
5591 *
5592 * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation
5593 * may request, if implemented.
5594 *
5595 * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information
5596 * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be
5597 * used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed
5598 * to the suspend() operation instead.
5599 *
5600 * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
5601 * @ht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden.
5602 * If null, then none can be over-ridden.
5603 * @vht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden.
5604 * If null, then none can be over-ridden.
5605 *
5606 * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must
5607 * not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection.
5608 *
5609 * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device
5610 * supports for ACL.
5611 *
5612 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
5613 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are
5614 * the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element")
5615 * and are in the same format as in the information element. See
5616 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default
5617 * extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified
5618 * for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab.
5619 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
5620 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
5621 * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type
5622 * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended
5623 * capabilities are specified separately.
5624 * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information
5625 *
5626 * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware
5627 * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands
5628 * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware
5629 * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events
5630 *
5631 * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode
5632 * (including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The
5633 * driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in
5634 * some cases, but may not always reach.
5635 *
5636 * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons
5637 * and probe responses. This value should be set if the driver
5638 * wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means
5639 * infinite.
5640 * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported
5641 * by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the
5642 * attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr.
5643 *
5644 * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a
5645 * bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values. For instance, for
5646 * NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
5647 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
5648 *
5649 * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit
5650 * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit
5651 * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum
5652 *
5653 * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using
5654 * wake_tx_queue
5655 *
5656 * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP
5657 * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not
5658 * HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues.
5659 * @support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect.
5660 *
5661 * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities
5662 *
5663 * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the
5664 * device has
5665 * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
5666 * supported by the driver for each vif
5667 * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
5668 * supported by the driver for each peer
5669 * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for
5670 * long/short retry configuration
5671 *
5672 * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for
5673 * configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and
5674 * %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes
5675 * @sar_capa: SAR control capabilities
5676 * @rfkill: a pointer to the rfkill structure
5677 *
5678 * @mbssid_max_interfaces: maximum number of interfaces supported by the driver
5679 * in a multiple BSSID set. This field must be set to a non-zero value
5680 * by the driver to advertise MBSSID support.
5681 * @ema_max_profile_periodicity: maximum profile periodicity supported by
5682 * the driver. Setting this field to a non-zero value indicates that the
5683 * driver supports enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP).
5684 * @max_num_akm_suites: maximum number of AKM suites allowed for
5685 * configuration through %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
5686 * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP. Set to NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES if not set by
5687 * driver. If set by driver minimum allowed value is
5688 * NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES in order to avoid compatibility issues with
5689 * legacy userspace and maximum allowed value is
5690 * CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES.
5691 *
5692 * @hw_timestamp_max_peers: maximum number of peers that the driver supports
5693 * enabling HW timestamping for concurrently. Setting this field to a
5694 * non-zero value indicates that the driver supports HW timestamping.
5695 * A value of %CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS indicates the driver
5696 * supports enabling HW timestamping for all peers (i.e. no need to
5697 * specify a mac address).
5698 *
5699 * @radio: radios belonging to this wiphy
5700 * @n_radio: number of radios
5701 */
5702 struct wiphy {
5703 struct mutex mtx;
5704
5705 /* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */
5706
5707 u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN];
5708 u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN];
5709
5710 struct mac_address *addresses;
5711
5712 const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes;
5713
5714 const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations;
5715 int n_iface_combinations;
5716 u16 software_iftypes;
5717
5718 u16 n_addresses;
5719
5720 /* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */
5721 u16 interface_modes;
5722
5723 u16 max_acl_mac_addrs;
5724
5725 u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features;
5726 u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)];
5727
5728 u32 ap_sme_capa;
5729
5730 enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type;
5731
5732 int bss_priv_size;
5733 u8 max_scan_ssids;
5734 u8 max_sched_scan_reqs;
5735 u8 max_sched_scan_ssids;
5736 u8 max_match_sets;
5737 u16 max_scan_ie_len;
5738 u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len;
5739 u32 max_sched_scan_plans;
5740 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval;
5741 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations;
5742
5743 int n_cipher_suites;
5744 const u32 *cipher_suites;
5745
5746 int n_akm_suites;
5747 const u32 *akm_suites;
5748
5749 const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites;
5750 unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites;
5751
5752 u8 retry_short;
5753 u8 retry_long;
5754 u32 frag_threshold;
5755 u32 rts_threshold;
5756 u8 coverage_class;
5757
5758 char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN];
5759 u32 hw_version;
5760
5761 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
5762 const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan;
5763 struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config;
5764 #endif
5765
5766 u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration;
5767
5768 u8 max_num_pmkids;
5769
5770 u32 available_antennas_tx;
5771 u32 available_antennas_rx;
5772
5773 u32 probe_resp_offload;
5774
5775 const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask;
5776 u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5777
5778 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab;
5779 unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab;
5780
5781 const void *privid;
5782
5783 struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
5784
5785 void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5786 struct regulatory_request *request);
5787
5788 /* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */
5789
5790 const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd;
5791
5792 struct device dev;
5793
5794 bool registered;
5795
5796 struct dentry *debugfsdir;
5797
5798 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask;
5799 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask;
5800
5801 struct list_head wdev_list;
5802
5803 possible_net_t _net;
5804
5805 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
5806 const struct iw_handler_def *wext;
5807 #endif
5808
5809 const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce;
5810
5811 const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands;
5812 const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events;
5813 int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events;
5814
5815 u16 max_ap_assoc_sta;
5816
5817 u8 max_num_csa_counters;
5818
5819 u32 bss_select_support;
5820
5821 u8 nan_supported_bands;
5822
5823 u32 txq_limit;
5824 u32 txq_memory_limit;
5825 u32 txq_quantum;
5826
5827 unsigned long tx_queue_len;
5828
5829 u8 support_mbssid:1,
5830 support_only_he_mbssid:1;
5831
5832 const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa;
5833
5834 struct {
5835 u64 peer, vif;
5836 u8 max_retry;
5837 } tid_config_support;
5838
5839 u8 max_data_retry_count;
5840
5841 const struct cfg80211_sar_capa *sar_capa;
5842
5843 struct rfkill *rfkill;
5844
5845 u8 mbssid_max_interfaces;
5846 u8 ema_max_profile_periodicity;
5847 u16 max_num_akm_suites;
5848
5849 u16 hw_timestamp_max_peers;
5850
5851 int n_radio;
5852 const struct wiphy_radio *radio;
5853
5854 char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN);
5855 };
5856
wiphy_net(struct wiphy * wiphy)5857 static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5858 {
5859 return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net);
5860 }
5861
wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct net * net)5862 static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net)
5863 {
5864 write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net);
5865 }
5866
5867 /**
5868 * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy
5869 *
5870 * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return
5871 * Return: The priv of @wiphy.
5872 */
wiphy_priv(struct wiphy * wiphy)5873 static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5874 {
5875 BUG_ON(!wiphy);
5876 return &wiphy->priv;
5877 }
5878
5879 /**
5880 * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv
5881 *
5882 * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv
5883 * Return: The wiphy of @priv.
5884 */
priv_to_wiphy(void * priv)5885 static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv)
5886 {
5887 BUG_ON(!priv);
5888 return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv);
5889 }
5890
5891 /**
5892 * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy
5893 *
5894 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind
5895 * @dev: The device to parent it to
5896 */
set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct device * dev)5897 static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev)
5898 {
5899 wiphy->dev.parent = dev;
5900 }
5901
5902 /**
5903 * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer
5904 *
5905 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up
5906 * Return: The dev of @wiphy.
5907 */
wiphy_dev(struct wiphy * wiphy)5908 static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5909 {
5910 return wiphy->dev.parent;
5911 }
5912
5913 /**
5914 * wiphy_name - get wiphy name
5915 *
5916 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return
5917 * Return: The name of @wiphy.
5918 */
wiphy_name(const struct wiphy * wiphy)5919 static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy)
5920 {
5921 return dev_name(&wiphy->dev);
5922 }
5923
5924 /**
5925 * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5926 *
5927 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5928 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5929 * @requested_name: Request a particular name.
5930 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming.
5931 *
5932 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5933 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5934 *
5935 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5936 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5937 */
5938 struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv,
5939 const char *requested_name);
5940
5941 /**
5942 * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5943 *
5944 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5945 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5946 *
5947 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5948 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5949 *
5950 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5951 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5952 */
wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops * ops,int sizeof_priv)5953 static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops,
5954 int sizeof_priv)
5955 {
5956 return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL);
5957 }
5958
5959 /**
5960 * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211
5961 *
5962 * @wiphy: The wiphy to register.
5963 *
5964 * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code.
5965 */
5966 int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5967
5968 /* this is a define for better error reporting (file/line) */
5969 #define lockdep_assert_wiphy(wiphy) lockdep_assert_held(&(wiphy)->mtx)
5970
5971 /**
5972 * rcu_dereference_wiphy - rcu_dereference with debug checking
5973 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
5974 * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
5975 *
5976 * Do an rcu_dereference(p), but check caller either holds rcu_read_lock()
5977 * or RTNL. Note: Please prefer wiphy_dereference() or rcu_dereference().
5978 */
5979 #define rcu_dereference_wiphy(wiphy, p) \
5980 rcu_dereference_check(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
5981
5982 /**
5983 * wiphy_dereference - fetch RCU pointer when updates are prevented by wiphy mtx
5984 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
5985 * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
5986 *
5987 * Return: the value of the specified RCU-protected pointer, but omit the
5988 * READ_ONCE(), because caller holds the wiphy mutex used for updates.
5989 */
5990 #define wiphy_dereference(wiphy, p) \
5991 rcu_dereference_protected(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
5992
5993 /**
5994 * get_wiphy_regdom - get custom regdomain for the given wiphy
5995 * @wiphy: the wiphy to get the regdomain from
5996 *
5997 * Context: Requires any of RTNL, wiphy mutex or RCU protection.
5998 *
5999 * Return: pointer to the regulatory domain associated with the wiphy
6000 */
6001 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *get_wiphy_regdom(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6002
6003 /**
6004 * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211
6005 *
6006 * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister.
6007 *
6008 * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv
6009 * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding
6010 * request that is being handled.
6011 */
6012 void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6013
6014 /**
6015 * wiphy_free - free wiphy
6016 *
6017 * @wiphy: The wiphy to free
6018 */
6019 void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6020
6021 /* internal structs */
6022 struct cfg80211_conn;
6023 struct cfg80211_internal_bss;
6024 struct cfg80211_cached_keys;
6025 struct cfg80211_cqm_config;
6026
6027 /**
6028 * wiphy_lock - lock the wiphy
6029 * @wiphy: the wiphy to lock
6030 *
6031 * This is needed around registering and unregistering netdevs that
6032 * aren't created through cfg80211 calls, since that requires locking
6033 * in cfg80211 when the notifiers is called, but that cannot
6034 * differentiate which way it's called.
6035 *
6036 * It can also be used by drivers for their own purposes.
6037 *
6038 * When cfg80211 ops are called, the wiphy is already locked.
6039 *
6040 * Note that this makes sure that no workers that have been queued
6041 * with wiphy_queue_work() are running.
6042 */
wiphy_lock(struct wiphy * wiphy)6043 static inline void wiphy_lock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
6044 __acquires(&wiphy->mtx)
6045 {
6046 mutex_lock(&wiphy->mtx);
6047 __acquire(&wiphy->mtx);
6048 }
6049
6050 /**
6051 * wiphy_unlock - unlock the wiphy again
6052 * @wiphy: the wiphy to unlock
6053 */
wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy * wiphy)6054 static inline void wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
6055 __releases(&wiphy->mtx)
6056 {
6057 __release(&wiphy->mtx);
6058 mutex_unlock(&wiphy->mtx);
6059 }
6060
6061 DEFINE_GUARD(wiphy, struct wiphy *,
6062 mutex_lock(&_T->mtx),
6063 mutex_unlock(&_T->mtx))
6064
6065 struct wiphy_work;
6066 typedef void (*wiphy_work_func_t)(struct wiphy *, struct wiphy_work *);
6067
6068 struct wiphy_work {
6069 struct list_head entry;
6070 wiphy_work_func_t func;
6071 };
6072
wiphy_work_init(struct wiphy_work * work,wiphy_work_func_t func)6073 static inline void wiphy_work_init(struct wiphy_work *work,
6074 wiphy_work_func_t func)
6075 {
6076 INIT_LIST_HEAD(&work->entry);
6077 work->func = func;
6078 }
6079
6080 /**
6081 * wiphy_work_queue - queue work for the wiphy
6082 * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for
6083 * @work: the work item
6084 *
6085 * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work
6086 * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be
6087 * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running
6088 * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can
6089 * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires
6090 * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock().
6091 */
6092 void wiphy_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
6093
6094 /**
6095 * wiphy_work_cancel - cancel previously queued work
6096 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6097 * @work: the work to cancel
6098 *
6099 * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being
6100 * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6101 */
6102 void wiphy_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
6103
6104 /**
6105 * wiphy_work_flush - flush previously queued work
6106 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6107 * @work: the work to flush, this can be %NULL to flush all work
6108 *
6109 * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called
6110 * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6111 */
6112 void wiphy_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
6113
6114 struct wiphy_delayed_work {
6115 struct wiphy_work work;
6116 struct wiphy *wiphy;
6117 struct timer_list timer;
6118 };
6119
6120 void wiphy_delayed_work_timer(struct timer_list *t);
6121
wiphy_delayed_work_init(struct wiphy_delayed_work * dwork,wiphy_work_func_t func)6122 static inline void wiphy_delayed_work_init(struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork,
6123 wiphy_work_func_t func)
6124 {
6125 timer_setup(&dwork->timer, wiphy_delayed_work_timer, 0);
6126 wiphy_work_init(&dwork->work, func);
6127 }
6128
6129 /**
6130 * wiphy_delayed_work_queue - queue delayed work for the wiphy
6131 * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for
6132 * @dwork: the delayable worker
6133 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6134 *
6135 * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work
6136 * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be
6137 * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running
6138 * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can
6139 * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires
6140 * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock().
6141 */
6142 void wiphy_delayed_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6143 struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork,
6144 unsigned long delay);
6145
6146 /**
6147 * wiphy_delayed_work_cancel - cancel previously queued delayed work
6148 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6149 * @dwork: the delayed work to cancel
6150 *
6151 * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being
6152 * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6153 */
6154 void wiphy_delayed_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6155 struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
6156
6157 /**
6158 * wiphy_delayed_work_flush - flush previously queued delayed work
6159 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6160 * @dwork: the delayed work to flush
6161 *
6162 * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called
6163 * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6164 */
6165 void wiphy_delayed_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6166 struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
6167
6168 /**
6169 * wiphy_delayed_work_pending - Find out whether a wiphy delayable
6170 * work item is currently pending.
6171 *
6172 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6173 * @dwork: the delayed work in question
6174 *
6175 * Return: true if timer is pending, false otherwise
6176 *
6177 * How wiphy_delayed_work_queue() works is by setting a timer which
6178 * when it expires calls wiphy_work_queue() to queue the wiphy work.
6179 * Because wiphy_delayed_work_queue() uses mod_timer(), if it is
6180 * called twice and the second call happens before the first call
6181 * deadline, the work will rescheduled for the second deadline and
6182 * won't run before that.
6183 *
6184 * wiphy_delayed_work_pending() can be used to detect if calling
6185 * wiphy_work_delayed_work_queue() would start a new work schedule
6186 * or delayed a previous one. As seen below it cannot be used to
6187 * detect precisely if the work has finished to execute nor if it
6188 * is currently executing.
6189 *
6190 * CPU0 CPU1
6191 * wiphy_delayed_work_queue(wk)
6192 * mod_timer(wk->timer)
6193 * wiphy_delayed_work_pending(wk) -> true
6194 *
6195 * [...]
6196 * expire_timers(wk->timer)
6197 * detach_timer(wk->timer)
6198 * wiphy_delayed_work_pending(wk) -> false
6199 * wk->timer->function() |
6200 * wiphy_work_queue(wk) | delayed work pending
6201 * list_add_tail() | returns false but
6202 * queue_work(cfg80211_wiphy_work) | wk->func() has not
6203 * | been run yet
6204 * [...] |
6205 * cfg80211_wiphy_work() |
6206 * wk->func() V
6207 *
6208 */
6209 bool wiphy_delayed_work_pending(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6210 struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
6211
6212 /**
6213 * enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power - regulatory power for an Access Point
6214 *
6215 * @IEEE80211_REG_UNSET_AP: Access Point has no regulatory power mode
6216 * @IEEE80211_REG_LPI_AP: Indoor Access Point
6217 * @IEEE80211_REG_SP_AP: Standard power Access Point
6218 * @IEEE80211_REG_VLP_AP: Very low power Access Point
6219 */
6220 enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power {
6221 IEEE80211_REG_UNSET_AP,
6222 IEEE80211_REG_LPI_AP,
6223 IEEE80211_REG_SP_AP,
6224 IEEE80211_REG_VLP_AP,
6225 };
6226
6227 /**
6228 * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state
6229 *
6230 * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver
6231 * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this
6232 * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.)
6233 * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will
6234 * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device,
6235 * however, drivers must lock the wiphy before registering or
6236 * unregistering netdevs if they pre-create any netdevs (in ops
6237 * called from cfg80211, the wiphy is already locked.)
6238 *
6239 * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver
6240 * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as
6241 * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be
6242 * allocated outside of callback operations that return it.
6243 *
6244 * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description
6245 * @iftype: interface type
6246 * @registered: is this wdev already registered with cfg80211
6247 * @registering: indicates we're doing registration under wiphy lock
6248 * for the notifier
6249 * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces
6250 * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL
6251 * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this
6252 * wireless device if it has no netdev
6253 * @u: union containing data specific to @iftype
6254 * @connected: indicates if connected or not (STA mode)
6255 * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code
6256 * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling
6257 * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data
6258 * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data
6259 * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association
6260 * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements
6261 * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID
6262 * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID
6263 * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index
6264 * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index
6265 * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation
6266 * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity
6267 * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be
6268 * set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the
6269 * netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update
6270 * by cfg80211 on change_interface
6271 * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames
6272 * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated,
6273 * need to propagate the update to the driver
6274 * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL
6275 * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g.
6276 * the P2P Device.
6277 * @ps: powersave mode is enabled
6278 * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout
6279 * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application
6280 * registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode)
6281 * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data
6282 * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established
6283 * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type
6284 * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID
6285 * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work
6286 * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect
6287 * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing
6288 * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list
6289 * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID
6290 * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away
6291 * @cqm_rssi_work: (private) CQM RSSI reporting work
6292 * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state
6293 * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests
6294 * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock
6295 * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work
6296 * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last
6297 * unprotected beacon report
6298 * @links: array of %IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS elements containing @addr
6299 * @ap and @client for each link
6300 * @links.cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been
6301 * started
6302 * @links.cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was
6303 * entered.
6304 * @links.cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms
6305 * @valid_links: bitmap describing what elements of @links are valid
6306 * @radio_mask: Bitmask of radios that this interface is allowed to operate on.
6307 */
6308 struct wireless_dev {
6309 struct wiphy *wiphy;
6310 enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
6311
6312 /* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */
6313 struct list_head list;
6314 struct net_device *netdev;
6315
6316 u32 identifier;
6317
6318 struct list_head mgmt_registrations;
6319 u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1;
6320
6321 bool use_4addr, is_running, registered, registering;
6322
6323 u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16));
6324
6325 /* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */
6326 struct cfg80211_conn *conn;
6327 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys;
6328 enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type;
6329 u32 conn_owner_nlportid;
6330
6331 struct work_struct disconnect_wk;
6332 u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6333
6334 struct list_head event_list;
6335 spinlock_t event_lock;
6336
6337 u8 connected:1;
6338
6339 bool ps;
6340 int ps_timeout;
6341
6342 u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid;
6343
6344 u32 owner_nlportid;
6345 bool nl_owner_dead;
6346
6347 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
6348 /* wext data */
6349 struct {
6350 struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss;
6351 struct cfg80211_connect_params connect;
6352 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys;
6353 const u8 *ie;
6354 size_t ie_len;
6355 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6356 u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6357 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6358 s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key;
6359 bool prev_bssid_valid;
6360 } wext;
6361 #endif
6362
6363 struct wiphy_work cqm_rssi_work;
6364 struct cfg80211_cqm_config __rcu *cqm_config;
6365
6366 struct list_head pmsr_list;
6367 spinlock_t pmsr_lock;
6368 struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk;
6369
6370 unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported;
6371
6372 union {
6373 struct {
6374 u8 connected_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
6375 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6376 u8 ssid_len;
6377 } client;
6378 struct {
6379 int beacon_interval;
6380 struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
6381 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6382 u8 id[IEEE80211_MAX_MESH_ID_LEN];
6383 u8 id_len, id_up_len;
6384 } mesh;
6385 struct {
6386 struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
6387 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6388 u8 ssid_len;
6389 } ap;
6390 struct {
6391 struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss;
6392 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6393 int beacon_interval;
6394 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6395 u8 ssid_len;
6396 } ibss;
6397 struct {
6398 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6399 } ocb;
6400 } u;
6401
6402 struct {
6403 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
6404 union {
6405 struct {
6406 unsigned int beacon_interval;
6407 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6408 } ap;
6409 struct {
6410 struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss;
6411 } client;
6412 };
6413
6414 bool cac_started;
6415 unsigned long cac_start_time;
6416 unsigned int cac_time_ms;
6417 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
6418 u16 valid_links;
6419
6420 u32 radio_mask;
6421 };
6422
wdev_address(struct wireless_dev * wdev)6423 static inline const u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6424 {
6425 if (wdev->netdev)
6426 return wdev->netdev->dev_addr;
6427 return wdev->address;
6428 }
6429
wdev_running(struct wireless_dev * wdev)6430 static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6431 {
6432 if (wdev->netdev)
6433 return netif_running(wdev->netdev);
6434 return wdev->is_running;
6435 }
6436
6437 /**
6438 * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev
6439 *
6440 * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return
6441 * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev.
6442 */
wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev * wdev)6443 static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6444 {
6445 BUG_ON(!wdev);
6446 return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy);
6447 }
6448
6449 /**
6450 * wdev_chandef - return chandef pointer from wireless_dev
6451 * @wdev: the wdev
6452 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO
6453 *
6454 * Return: The chandef depending on the mode, or %NULL.
6455 */
6456 struct cfg80211_chan_def *wdev_chandef(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6457 unsigned int link_id);
6458
WARN_INVALID_LINK_ID(struct wireless_dev * wdev,unsigned int link_id)6459 static inline void WARN_INVALID_LINK_ID(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6460 unsigned int link_id)
6461 {
6462 WARN_ON(link_id && !wdev->valid_links);
6463 WARN_ON(wdev->valid_links &&
6464 !(wdev->valid_links & BIT(link_id)));
6465 }
6466
6467 #define for_each_valid_link(link_info, link_id) \
6468 for (link_id = 0; \
6469 link_id < ((link_info)->valid_links ? \
6470 ARRAY_SIZE((link_info)->links) : 1); \
6471 link_id++) \
6472 if (!(link_info)->valid_links || \
6473 ((link_info)->valid_links & BIT(link_id)))
6474
6475 /**
6476 * DOC: Utility functions
6477 *
6478 * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful.
6479 */
6480
6481 /**
6482 * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel
6483 *
6484 * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel
6485 * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel
6486 * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b
6487 */
6488 static inline bool
ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel * a,struct ieee80211_channel * b)6489 ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a,
6490 struct ieee80211_channel *b)
6491 {
6492 return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq &&
6493 a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset);
6494 }
6495
6496 /**
6497 * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz
6498 * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert
6499 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz)
6500 */
6501 static inline u32
ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel * chan)6502 ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
6503 {
6504 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset;
6505 }
6506
6507 /**
6508 * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan
6509 *
6510 * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ
6511 * @chan: channel
6512 * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq
6513 */
6514 enum nl80211_chan_width
6515 ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
6516
6517 /**
6518 * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency
6519 * @chan: channel number
6520 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
6521 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
6522 */
6523 u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band);
6524
6525 /**
6526 * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency
6527 * @chan: channel number
6528 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
6529 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
6530 */
6531 static inline int
ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan,enum nl80211_band band)6532 ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band)
6533 {
6534 return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band));
6535 }
6536
6537 /**
6538 * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
6539 * @freq: center frequency in KHz
6540 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
6541 */
6542 int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq);
6543
6544 /**
6545 * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
6546 * @freq: center frequency in MHz
6547 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
6548 */
6549 static inline int
ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)6550 ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)
6551 {
6552 return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
6553 }
6554
6555 /**
6556 * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified
6557 * frequency
6558 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
6559 * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel
6560 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
6561 */
6562 struct ieee80211_channel *
6563 ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq);
6564
6565 /**
6566 * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency
6567 *
6568 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
6569 * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel
6570 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
6571 */
6572 static inline struct ieee80211_channel *
ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy * wiphy,int freq)6573 ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq)
6574 {
6575 return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
6576 }
6577
6578 /**
6579 * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC
6580 * @chan: control channel to check
6581 *
6582 * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in
6583 * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3
6584 *
6585 * Return: %true if channel is a PSC, %false otherwise
6586 */
cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel * chan)6587 static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
6588 {
6589 if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ)
6590 return false;
6591
6592 return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5;
6593 }
6594
6595 /**
6596 * cfg80211_radio_chandef_valid - Check if the radio supports the chandef
6597 *
6598 * @radio: wiphy radio
6599 * @chandef: chandef for current channel
6600 *
6601 * Return: whether or not the given chandef is valid for the given radio
6602 */
6603 bool cfg80211_radio_chandef_valid(const struct wiphy_radio *radio,
6604 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
6605
6606 /**
6607 * cfg80211_wdev_channel_allowed - Check if the wdev may use the channel
6608 *
6609 * @wdev: the wireless device
6610 * @chan: channel to check
6611 *
6612 * Return: whether or not the wdev may use the channel
6613 */
6614 bool cfg80211_wdev_channel_allowed(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6615 struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
6616
6617 /**
6618 * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate
6619 *
6620 * @sband: the band to look for rates in
6621 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates
6622 * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate
6623 *
6624 * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that
6625 * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map,
6626 * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of
6627 * rates in the band's bitrate table.
6628 */
6629 const struct ieee80211_rate *
6630 ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6631 u32 basic_rates, int bitrate);
6632
6633 /**
6634 * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band
6635 * @sband: the band to look for rates in
6636 *
6637 * Return: a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given band, bits
6638 * are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array.
6639 */
6640 u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband);
6641
6642 /*
6643 * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support
6644 *
6645 * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c
6646 * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst
6647 */
6648
6649 struct radiotap_align_size {
6650 uint8_t align:4, size:4;
6651 };
6652
6653 struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace {
6654 const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size;
6655 int n_bits;
6656 uint32_t oui;
6657 uint8_t subns;
6658 };
6659
6660 struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces {
6661 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns;
6662 int n_ns;
6663 };
6664
6665 /**
6666 * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args
6667 * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call
6668 * to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next()
6669 * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each
6670 * call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after
6671 * ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to
6672 * the beginning of the actual data portion
6673 * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience
6674 * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition
6675 * (or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown)
6676 * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default
6677 * radiotap namespace or not
6678 *
6679 * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through
6680 * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering
6681 * @_arg_index: next argument index
6682 * @_arg: next argument pointer
6683 * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32
6684 * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present
6685 * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions
6686 * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data
6687 * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the
6688 * next bitmap word
6689 *
6690 * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore
6691 * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally.
6692 */
6693
6694 struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator {
6695 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader;
6696 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns;
6697 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace;
6698
6699 unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data;
6700 __le32 *_next_bitmap;
6701
6702 unsigned char *this_arg;
6703 int this_arg_index;
6704 int this_arg_size;
6705
6706 int is_radiotap_ns;
6707
6708 int _max_length;
6709 int _arg_index;
6710 uint32_t _bitmap_shifter;
6711 int _reset_on_ext;
6712 };
6713
6714 int
6715 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator,
6716 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header,
6717 int max_length,
6718 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns);
6719
6720 int
6721 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator);
6722
6723
6724 extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6];
6725 extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6];
6726
6727 /**
6728 * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data
6729 *
6730 * @skb: the frame
6731 *
6732 * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function
6733 * returns the 802.11 header length.
6734 *
6735 * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption
6736 * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid
6737 * 802.11 header.
6738 */
6739 unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb);
6740
6741 /**
6742 * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control
6743 * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format
6744 * Return: The header length in bytes.
6745 */
6746 unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc);
6747
6748 /**
6749 * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length
6750 * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field
6751 * (first byte) will be accessed
6752 * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at
6753 * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present.
6754 */
6755 unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr);
6756
6757 /**
6758 * DOC: Data path helpers
6759 *
6760 * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers
6761 * functions that help implement the data path for devices
6762 * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device.
6763 */
6764
6765 /**
6766 * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
6767 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
6768 * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead
6769 * of it being pushed into the SKB
6770 * @addr: the device MAC address
6771 * @iftype: the virtual interface type
6772 * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header
6773 * @is_amsdu: true if the 802.11 header is A-MSDU
6774 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6775 */
6776 int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr,
6777 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
6778 u8 data_offset, bool is_amsdu);
6779
6780 /**
6781 * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
6782 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
6783 * @addr: the device MAC address
6784 * @iftype: the virtual interface type
6785 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6786 */
ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff * skb,const u8 * addr,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)6787 static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr,
6788 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
6789 {
6790 return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0, false);
6791 }
6792
6793 /**
6794 * ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu - check if subframe lengths of an A-MSDU are valid
6795 *
6796 * This is used to detect non-standard A-MSDU frames, e.g. the ones generated
6797 * by ath10k and ath11k, where the subframe length includes the length of the
6798 * mesh control field.
6799 *
6800 * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
6801 * @mesh_hdr: the type of mesh header to test
6802 * 0: non-mesh A-MSDU length field
6803 * 1: big-endian mesh A-MSDU length field
6804 * 2: little-endian mesh A-MSDU length field
6805 * Returns: true if subframe header lengths are valid for the @mesh_hdr mode
6806 */
6807 bool ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 mesh_hdr);
6808
6809 /**
6810 * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame
6811 *
6812 * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames.
6813 * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully
6814 * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function.
6815 *
6816 * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
6817 * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and
6818 * initialized by the caller.
6819 * @addr: The device MAC address.
6820 * @iftype: The device interface type.
6821 * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list.
6822 * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
6823 * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
6824 * @mesh_control: see mesh_hdr in ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu
6825 */
6826 void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list,
6827 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
6828 const unsigned int extra_headroom,
6829 const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa,
6830 u8 mesh_control);
6831
6832 /**
6833 * ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto - get RFC1042 or bridge tunnel encap protocol
6834 *
6835 * Check for RFC1042 or bridge tunnel header and fetch the encapsulated
6836 * protocol.
6837 *
6838 * @hdr: pointer to the MSDU payload
6839 * @proto: destination pointer to store the protocol
6840 * Return: true if encapsulation was found
6841 */
6842 bool ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto(const void *hdr, __be16 *proto);
6843
6844 /**
6845 * ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr - strip mesh header from converted 802.3 frames
6846 *
6847 * Strip the mesh header, which was left in by ieee80211_data_to_8023 as part
6848 * of the MSDU data. Also move any source/destination addresses from the mesh
6849 * header to the ethernet header (if present).
6850 *
6851 * @skb: The 802.3 frame with embedded mesh header
6852 *
6853 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6854 */
6855 int ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr(struct sk_buff *skb);
6856
6857 /**
6858 * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame
6859 * @skb: the data frame
6860 * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use
6861 * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag.
6862 */
6863 unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb,
6864 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
6865
6866 /**
6867 * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data
6868 *
6869 * @eid: element ID
6870 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6871 * @len: length of data
6872 * @match: byte array to match
6873 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
6874 * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match.
6875 * Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers
6876 * the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take
6877 * the data portion instead.
6878 *
6879 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6880 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6881 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6882 * requested element struct.
6883 *
6884 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6885 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
6886 * byte array to match.
6887 */
6888 const struct element *
6889 cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
6890 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
6891 unsigned int match_offset);
6892
6893 /**
6894 * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data
6895 *
6896 * @eid: element ID
6897 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6898 * @len: length of data
6899 * @match: byte array to match
6900 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
6901 * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match.
6902 * If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero.
6903 * Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first
6904 * byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and
6905 * the second byte is the IE length.
6906 *
6907 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6908 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6909 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first
6910 * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
6911 * element ID.
6912 *
6913 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6914 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
6915 * byte array to match.
6916 */
6917 static inline const u8 *
cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,unsigned int len,const u8 * match,unsigned int match_len,unsigned int match_offset)6918 cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
6919 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
6920 unsigned int match_offset)
6921 {
6922 /* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is
6923 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well.
6924 */
6925 if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) ||
6926 (!match_len && match_offset)))
6927 return NULL;
6928
6929 return (const void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len,
6930 match, match_len,
6931 match_offset ?
6932 match_offset - 2 : 0);
6933 }
6934
6935 /**
6936 * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data
6937 *
6938 * @eid: element ID
6939 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6940 * @len: length of data
6941 *
6942 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6943 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6944 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6945 * requested element struct.
6946 *
6947 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6948 * having to fit into the given data.
6949 */
6950 static inline const struct element *
cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,int len)6951 cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6952 {
6953 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
6954 }
6955
6956 /**
6957 * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data
6958 *
6959 * @eid: element ID
6960 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6961 * @len: length of data
6962 *
6963 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6964 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6965 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
6966 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
6967 *
6968 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6969 * having to fit into the given data.
6970 */
cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,int len)6971 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6972 {
6973 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
6974 }
6975
6976 /**
6977 * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data
6978 *
6979 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
6980 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6981 * @len: length of data
6982 *
6983 * Return: %NULL if the extended element could not be found or if
6984 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6985 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6986 * requested element struct.
6987 *
6988 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6989 * having to fit into the given data.
6990 */
6991 static inline const struct element *
cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid,const u8 * ies,int len)6992 cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6993 {
6994 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
6995 &ext_eid, 1, 0);
6996 }
6997
6998 /**
6999 * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data
7000 *
7001 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
7002 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
7003 * @len: length of data
7004 *
7005 * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if
7006 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
7007 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
7008 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
7009 *
7010 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
7011 * having to fit into the given data.
7012 */
cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid,const u8 * ies,int len)7013 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
7014 {
7015 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
7016 &ext_eid, 1, 2);
7017 }
7018
7019 /**
7020 * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data
7021 *
7022 * @oui: vendor OUI
7023 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
7024 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
7025 * @len: length of data
7026 *
7027 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
7028 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise
7029 * return the element structure for the requested element.
7030 *
7031 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
7032 * the given data.
7033 */
7034 const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
7035 const u8 *ies,
7036 unsigned int len);
7037
7038 /**
7039 * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data
7040 *
7041 * @oui: vendor OUI
7042 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
7043 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
7044 * @len: length of data
7045 *
7046 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
7047 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to
7048 * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
7049 * element ID.
7050 *
7051 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
7052 * the given data.
7053 */
7054 static inline const u8 *
cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui,int oui_type,const u8 * ies,unsigned int len)7055 cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
7056 const u8 *ies, unsigned int len)
7057 {
7058 return (const void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len);
7059 }
7060
7061 /**
7062 * enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret - reduced neighbor report iteration state
7063 * @RNR_ITER_CONTINUE: continue iterating with the next entry
7064 * @RNR_ITER_BREAK: break iteration and return success
7065 * @RNR_ITER_ERROR: break iteration and return error
7066 */
7067 enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret {
7068 RNR_ITER_CONTINUE,
7069 RNR_ITER_BREAK,
7070 RNR_ITER_ERROR,
7071 };
7072
7073 /**
7074 * cfg80211_iter_rnr - iterate reduced neighbor report entries
7075 * @elems: the frame elements to iterate RNR elements and then
7076 * their entries in
7077 * @elems_len: length of the elements
7078 * @iter: iteration function, see also &enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret
7079 * for the return value
7080 * @iter_data: additional data passed to the iteration function
7081 * Return: %true on success (after successfully iterating all entries
7082 * or if the iteration function returned %RNR_ITER_BREAK),
7083 * %false on error (iteration function returned %RNR_ITER_ERROR
7084 * or elements were malformed.)
7085 */
7086 bool cfg80211_iter_rnr(const u8 *elems, size_t elems_len,
7087 enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret
7088 (*iter)(void *data, u8 type,
7089 const struct ieee80211_neighbor_ap_info *info,
7090 const u8 *tbtt_info, u8 tbtt_info_len),
7091 void *iter_data);
7092
7093 /**
7094 * cfg80211_defragment_element - Defrag the given element data into a buffer
7095 *
7096 * @elem: the element to defragment
7097 * @ies: elements where @elem is contained
7098 * @ieslen: length of @ies
7099 * @data: buffer to store element data, or %NULL to just determine size
7100 * @data_len: length of @data, or 0
7101 * @frag_id: the element ID of fragments
7102 *
7103 * Return: length of @data, or -EINVAL on error
7104 *
7105 * Copy out all data from an element that may be fragmented into @data, while
7106 * skipping all headers.
7107 *
7108 * The function uses memmove() internally. It is acceptable to defragment an
7109 * element in-place.
7110 */
7111 ssize_t cfg80211_defragment_element(const struct element *elem, const u8 *ies,
7112 size_t ieslen, u8 *data, size_t data_len,
7113 u8 frag_id);
7114
7115 /**
7116 * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame
7117 *
7118 * @dev: network device
7119 * @addr: STA MAC address
7120 *
7121 * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge
7122 * devices upon STA association.
7123 */
7124 void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
7125
7126 /**
7127 * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure
7128 *
7129 * TODO
7130 */
7131
7132 /**
7133 * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain
7134 * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting
7135 * conflicts)
7136 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain
7137 * should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you
7138 * set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted
7139 * alpha2.
7140 *
7141 * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core
7142 * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by
7143 * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory
7144 * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain.
7145 * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried
7146 * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country.
7147 *
7148 * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call.
7149 * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(),
7150 * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw().
7151 *
7152 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
7153 * an -ENOMEM.
7154 *
7155 * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM.
7156 */
7157 int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2);
7158
7159 /**
7160 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers
7161 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
7162 * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
7163 *
7164 * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they
7165 * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more
7166 * information.
7167 *
7168 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
7169 */
7170 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7171 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
7172
7173 /**
7174 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync - set regdom for self-managed drivers
7175 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
7176 * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
7177 *
7178 * This functions requires the RTNL and the wiphy mutex to be held and
7179 * applies the new regdomain synchronously to this wiphy. For more details
7180 * see regulatory_set_wiphy_regd().
7181 *
7182 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
7183 */
7184 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7185 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
7186
7187 /**
7188 * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain
7189 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
7190 * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy
7191 *
7192 * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply
7193 * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory
7194 * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The
7195 * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous
7196 * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a
7197 * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled.
7198 * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag
7199 * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy
7200 * that called this helper.
7201 */
7202 void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7203 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd);
7204
7205 /**
7206 * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency
7207 * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for
7208 * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for
7209 *
7210 * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on
7211 * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain
7212 * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received
7213 * and processed already.
7214 *
7215 * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule
7216 * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to
7217 * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return
7218 * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even
7219 * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band.
7220 * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is
7221 * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific.
7222 */
7223 const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7224 u32 center_freq);
7225
7226 /**
7227 * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name
7228 * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator
7229 *
7230 * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a
7231 * proper string representation.
7232 *
7233 * Return: pointer to string representation of the initiator
7234 */
7235 const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator);
7236
7237 /**
7238 * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom
7239 * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked.
7240 *
7241 * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI).
7242 *
7243 * Return: %true if allowed, %false otherwise
7244 */
7245 bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7246
7247 /**
7248 * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions
7249 *
7250 */
7251
7252 /**
7253 * reg_query_regdb_wmm - Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule
7254 * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively
7255 *
7256 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried.
7257 * @freq: the frequency (in MHz) to be queried.
7258 * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db.
7259 *
7260 * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to query
7261 * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given
7262 * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations.
7263 *
7264 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
7265 * an -ENODATA.
7266 *
7267 * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA.
7268 */
7269 int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq,
7270 struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule);
7271
7272 /*
7273 * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification
7274 * functions and BSS handling helpers
7275 */
7276
7277 /**
7278 * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished
7279 *
7280 * @request: the corresponding scan request
7281 * @info: information about the completed scan
7282 */
7283 void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request,
7284 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
7285
7286 /**
7287 * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available
7288 *
7289 * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results
7290 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7291 */
7292 void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7293
7294 /**
7295 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
7296 *
7297 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
7298 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7299 *
7300 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
7301 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver
7302 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
7303 */
7304 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7305
7306 /**
7307 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
7308 *
7309 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
7310 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7311 *
7312 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
7313 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver
7314 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
7315 * This function should be called with the wiphy mutex held.
7316 */
7317 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7318
7319 /**
7320 * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame
7321 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
7322 * @data: the BSS metadata
7323 * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon)
7324 * @len: length of the management frame
7325 * @gfp: context flags
7326 *
7327 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
7328 * the BSS should be updated/added.
7329 *
7330 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
7331 * Or %NULL on error.
7332 */
7333 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
7334 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7335 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
7336 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
7337 gfp_t gfp);
7338
7339 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,struct ieee80211_mgmt * mgmt,size_t len,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)7340 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7341 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
7342 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
7343 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
7344 {
7345 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
7346 .chan = rx_channel,
7347 .signal = signal,
7348 };
7349
7350 return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
7351 }
7352
7353 /**
7354 * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID
7355 * @bssid: transmitter BSSID
7356 * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element
7357 * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element
7358 * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID
7359 */
cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 * bssid,u8 max_bssid,u8 mbssid_index,u8 * new_bssid)7360 static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid,
7361 u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid)
7362 {
7363 u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid);
7364 u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0);
7365 u64 new_bssid_u64;
7366
7367 new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask;
7368
7369 new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask;
7370
7371 u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid);
7372 }
7373
7374 /**
7375 * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited
7376 * @element: element to check
7377 * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element
7378 *
7379 * Return: %true if should be inherited, %false otherwise
7380 */
7381 bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element,
7382 const struct element *non_inherit_element);
7383
7384 /**
7385 * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs
7386 * @ie: ies
7387 * @ielen: length of IEs
7388 * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element
7389 * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile)
7390 * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile
7391 * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length
7392 *
7393 * Return: the number of bytes merged
7394 */
7395 size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7396 const struct element *mbssid_elem,
7397 const struct element *sub_elem,
7398 u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len);
7399
7400 /**
7401 * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from
7402 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is
7403 * from a beacon or probe response
7404 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon
7405 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response
7406 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_S1G_BEACON: data comes from an S1G beacon
7407 */
7408 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type {
7409 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN,
7410 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON,
7411 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP,
7412 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_S1G_BEACON,
7413 };
7414
7415 /**
7416 * cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number - returns the channel number from ies
7417 * @ie: IEs
7418 * @ielen: length of IEs
7419 * @band: enum nl80211_band of the channel
7420 *
7421 * Return: the channel number, or -1 if none could be determined.
7422 */
7423 int cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7424 enum nl80211_band band);
7425
7426 /**
7427 * cfg80211_ssid_eq - compare two SSIDs
7428 * @a: first SSID
7429 * @b: second SSID
7430 *
7431 * Return: %true if SSIDs are equal, %false otherwise.
7432 */
7433 static inline bool
cfg80211_ssid_eq(struct cfg80211_ssid * a,struct cfg80211_ssid * b)7434 cfg80211_ssid_eq(struct cfg80211_ssid *a, struct cfg80211_ssid *b)
7435 {
7436 if (WARN_ON(!a || !b))
7437 return false;
7438 if (a->ssid_len != b->ssid_len)
7439 return false;
7440 return memcmp(a->ssid, b->ssid, a->ssid_len) ? false : true;
7441 }
7442
7443 /**
7444 * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS
7445 *
7446 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
7447 * @data: the BSS metadata
7448 * @ftype: frame type (if known)
7449 * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS
7450 * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0)
7451 * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer
7452 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer
7453 * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer
7454 * @ielen: length of the additional IEs
7455 * @gfp: context flags
7456 *
7457 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
7458 * the BSS should be updated/added.
7459 *
7460 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
7461 * Or %NULL on error.
7462 */
7463 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
7464 cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7465 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
7466 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
7467 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
7468 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7469 gfp_t gfp);
7470
7471 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,const u8 * bssid,u64 tsf,u16 capability,u16 beacon_interval,const u8 * ie,size_t ielen,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)7472 cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7473 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
7474 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
7475 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
7476 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7477 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
7478 {
7479 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
7480 .chan = rx_channel,
7481 .signal = signal,
7482 };
7483
7484 return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
7485 capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
7486 gfp);
7487 }
7488
7489 /**
7490 * __cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
7491 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7492 * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
7493 * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
7494 * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
7495 * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
7496 * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
7497 * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
7498 * @use_for: indicates which use is intended
7499 *
7500 * Return: Reference-counted BSS on success. %NULL on error.
7501 */
7502 struct cfg80211_bss *__cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7503 struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7504 const u8 *bssid,
7505 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
7506 enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
7507 enum ieee80211_privacy privacy,
7508 u32 use_for);
7509
7510 /**
7511 * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
7512 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7513 * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
7514 * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
7515 * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
7516 * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
7517 * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
7518 * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
7519 *
7520 * This version implies regular usage, %NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL.
7521 *
7522 * Return: Reference-counted BSS on success. %NULL on error.
7523 */
7524 static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * channel,const u8 * bssid,const u8 * ssid,size_t ssid_len,enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,enum ieee80211_privacy privacy)7525 cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7526 const u8 *bssid, const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
7527 enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
7528 enum ieee80211_privacy privacy)
7529 {
7530 return __cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, bssid, ssid, ssid_len,
7531 bss_type, privacy,
7532 NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL);
7533 }
7534
7535 static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * channel,const u8 * ssid,size_t ssid_len)7536 cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7537 struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7538 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len)
7539 {
7540 return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len,
7541 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
7542 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY);
7543 }
7544
7545 /**
7546 * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct
7547 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7548 * @bss: the BSS struct to reference
7549 *
7550 * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct.
7551 */
7552 void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7553
7554 /**
7555 * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct
7556 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7557 * @bss: the BSS struct
7558 *
7559 * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct.
7560 */
7561 void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7562
7563 /**
7564 * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures
7565 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7566 * @bss: the bss to remove
7567 *
7568 * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures
7569 * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this
7570 * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time
7571 * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all.
7572 */
7573 void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7574
7575 /**
7576 * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries
7577 *
7578 * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy
7579 * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not
7580 * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB.
7581 *
7582 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7583 * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel
7584 * of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel.
7585 * @iter: the iterator function to call
7586 * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function
7587 */
7588 void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7589 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7590 void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7591 struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
7592 void *data),
7593 void *iter_data);
7594
7595 /**
7596 * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame
7597 * @dev: network device
7598 * @buf: authentication frame (header + body)
7599 * @len: length of the frame data
7600 *
7601 * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or
7602 * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode.
7603 * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must
7604 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7605 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
7606 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7607 * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed
7608 * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used
7609 * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function
7610 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead.
7611 *
7612 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7613 */
7614 void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
7615
7616 /**
7617 * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication
7618 * @dev: network device
7619 * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out
7620 *
7621 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's
7622 * mutex.
7623 */
7624 void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
7625
7626 /**
7627 * struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data - association response data
7628 * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body)
7629 * @len: length of the frame data
7630 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format
7631 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
7632 * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame
7633 * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data
7634 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address (in case of MLO)
7635 * @links: per-link information indexed by link ID, use links[0] for
7636 * non-MLO connections
7637 * @links.bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the
7638 * pointer moves to cfg80211 in the call to cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp()
7639 * @links.status: Set this (along with a BSS pointer) for links that
7640 * were rejected by the AP.
7641 */
7642 struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data {
7643 const u8 *buf;
7644 size_t len;
7645 const u8 *req_ies;
7646 size_t req_ies_len;
7647 int uapsd_queues;
7648 const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7649 struct {
7650 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
7651 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7652 u16 status;
7653 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7654 };
7655
7656 /**
7657 * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response
7658 * @dev: network device
7659 * @data: association response data, &struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data
7660 *
7661 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
7662 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7663 *
7664 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7665 */
7666 void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev,
7667 const struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data *data);
7668
7669 /**
7670 * struct cfg80211_assoc_failure - association failure data
7671 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address, or %NULL
7672 * @bss: list of BSSes, must use entry 0 for non-MLO connections
7673 * (@ap_mld_addr is %NULL)
7674 * @timeout: indicates the association failed due to timeout, otherwise
7675 * the association was abandoned for a reason reported through some
7676 * other API (e.g. deauth RX)
7677 */
7678 struct cfg80211_assoc_failure {
7679 const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7680 struct cfg80211_bss *bss[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7681 bool timeout;
7682 };
7683
7684 /**
7685 * cfg80211_assoc_failure - notification of association failure
7686 * @dev: network device
7687 * @data: data describing the association failure
7688 *
7689 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7690 */
7691 void cfg80211_assoc_failure(struct net_device *dev,
7692 struct cfg80211_assoc_failure *data);
7693
7694 /**
7695 * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame
7696 * @dev: network device
7697 * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body)
7698 * @len: length of the frame data
7699 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired (include the nl80211 attribute)
7700 *
7701 * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in
7702 * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and
7703 * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the
7704 * corresponding wdev's mutex.
7705 */
7706 void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
7707 bool reconnect);
7708
7709 /**
7710 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame
7711 * @dev: network device
7712 * @buf: received management frame (header + body)
7713 * @len: length of the frame data
7714 *
7715 * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc
7716 * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the
7717 * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon
7718 * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while
7719 * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
7720 *
7721 * This function may sleep.
7722 */
7723 void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev,
7724 const u8 *buf, size_t len);
7725
7726 /**
7727 * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP)
7728 * @dev: network device
7729 * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame
7730 * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used
7731 * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing.
7732 * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets)
7733 * @gfp: allocation flags
7734 *
7735 * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a
7736 * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication()
7737 * primitive.
7738 */
7739 void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
7740 enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id,
7741 const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp);
7742
7743 /**
7744 * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS
7745 *
7746 * @dev: network device
7747 * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined
7748 * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined
7749 * @gfp: allocation flags
7750 *
7751 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or
7752 * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called,
7753 * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of
7754 * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called
7755 * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is
7756 * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest.
7757 */
7758 void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7759 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp);
7760
7761 /**
7762 * cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer
7763 * candidate
7764 *
7765 * @dev: network device
7766 * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate
7767 * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate
7768 * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer
7769 * @sig_dbm: signal level in dBm
7770 * @gfp: allocation flags
7771 *
7772 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been
7773 * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response.
7774 * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace.
7775 */
7776 void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev,
7777 const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len,
7778 int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp);
7779
7780 /**
7781 * DOC: RFkill integration
7782 *
7783 * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers,
7784 * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each
7785 * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated
7786 * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off. Drivers are
7787 * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down.
7788 *
7789 * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they
7790 * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211.
7791 * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here.
7792 */
7793
7794 /**
7795 * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason - notify cfg80211 about hw block state
7796 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7797 * @blocked: block status
7798 * @reason: one of reasons in &enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons
7799 */
7800 void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked,
7801 enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons reason);
7802
wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy * wiphy,bool blocked)7803 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked)
7804 {
7805 wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(wiphy, blocked,
7806 RFKILL_HARD_BLOCK_SIGNAL);
7807 }
7808
7809 /**
7810 * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill
7811 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7812 */
7813 void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7814
7815 /**
7816 * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill
7817 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7818 */
wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy * wiphy)7819 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy)
7820 {
7821 rfkill_pause_polling(wiphy->rfkill);
7822 }
7823
7824 /**
7825 * DOC: Vendor commands
7826 *
7827 * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that
7828 * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the
7829 * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with
7830 * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as
7831 * the configuration mechanism.
7832 *
7833 * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array
7834 * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one. Each command has an
7835 * OUI and sub command ID to identify it.
7836 *
7837 * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol
7838 * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular,
7839 * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any
7840 * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection
7841 * managers etc. need.
7842 */
7843
7844 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7845 enum nl80211_commands cmd,
7846 enum nl80211_attrs attr,
7847 int approxlen);
7848
7849 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7850 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7851 enum nl80211_commands cmd,
7852 enum nl80211_attrs attr,
7853 unsigned int portid,
7854 int vendor_event_idx,
7855 int approxlen, gfp_t gfp);
7856
7857 void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp);
7858
7859 /**
7860 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply
7861 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7862 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7863 * be put into the skb
7864 *
7865 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
7866 * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
7867 * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid.
7868 *
7869 * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in
7870 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
7871 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
7872 * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
7873 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
7874 * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute.
7875 * You must not modify the skb in any other way.
7876 *
7877 * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return
7878 * its error code as the result of the doit() operation.
7879 *
7880 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7881 */
7882 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen)7883 cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
7884 {
7885 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7886 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen);
7887 }
7888
7889 /**
7890 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb
7891 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7892 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb()
7893 *
7894 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
7895 * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should
7896 * return the error code. Note that this function consumes the
7897 * skb regardless of the return value.
7898 *
7899 * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
7900 */
7901 int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb);
7902
7903 /**
7904 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender - get the current sender netlink ID
7905 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7906 *
7907 * Return: the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler.
7908 *
7909 * Context: May only be called from a vendor command handler
7910 */
7911 unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7912
7913 /**
7914 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb
7915 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7916 * @wdev: the wireless device
7917 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
7918 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7919 * be put into the skb
7920 * @gfp: allocation flags
7921 *
7922 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
7923 * vendor-specific multicast group.
7924 *
7925 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
7926 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
7927 * attribute.
7928 *
7929 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
7930 * skb to send the event.
7931 *
7932 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7933 */
7934 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct wireless_dev * wdev,int approxlen,int event_idx,gfp_t gfp)7935 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7936 int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
7937 {
7938 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7939 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
7940 0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
7941 }
7942
7943 /**
7944 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb
7945 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7946 * @wdev: the wireless device
7947 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
7948 * @portid: port ID of the receiver
7949 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7950 * be put into the skb
7951 * @gfp: allocation flags
7952 *
7953 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to
7954 * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been
7955 * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take
7956 * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes.
7957 *
7958 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
7959 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
7960 * attribute.
7961 *
7962 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
7963 * skb to send the event.
7964 *
7965 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7966 */
7967 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct wireless_dev * wdev,unsigned int portid,int approxlen,int event_idx,gfp_t gfp)7968 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7969 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7970 unsigned int portid, int approxlen,
7971 int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
7972 {
7973 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7974 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
7975 portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
7976 }
7977
7978 /**
7979 * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event
7980 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc()
7981 * @gfp: allocation flags
7982 *
7983 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
7984 * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it.
7985 */
cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff * skb,gfp_t gfp)7986 static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
7987 {
7988 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
7989 }
7990
7991 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
7992 /**
7993 * DOC: Test mode
7994 *
7995 * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to
7996 * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance,
7997 * factory programming.
7998 *
7999 * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it. For more
8000 * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it.
8001 */
8002
8003 /**
8004 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply
8005 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8006 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
8007 * be put into the skb
8008 *
8009 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
8010 * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
8011 * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid.
8012 *
8013 * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in
8014 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
8015 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
8016 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
8017 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
8018 * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You
8019 * must not modify the skb in any other way.
8020 *
8021 * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return
8022 * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation.
8023 *
8024 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
8025 */
8026 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen)8027 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
8028 {
8029 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
8030 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen);
8031 }
8032
8033 /**
8034 * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb
8035 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
8036 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb()
8037 *
8038 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
8039 * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return
8040 * the error code. Note that this function consumes the skb
8041 * regardless of the return value.
8042 *
8043 * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
8044 */
cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff * skb)8045 static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb)
8046 {
8047 return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb);
8048 }
8049
8050 /**
8051 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event
8052 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8053 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
8054 * be put into the skb
8055 * @gfp: allocation flags
8056 *
8057 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
8058 * testmode multicast group.
8059 *
8060 * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with
8061 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As
8062 * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the
8063 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb
8064 * in any other way.
8065 *
8066 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the
8067 * skb to send the event.
8068 *
8069 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
8070 */
8071 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen,gfp_t gfp)8072 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp)
8073 {
8074 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
8075 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1,
8076 approxlen, gfp);
8077 }
8078
8079 /**
8080 * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event
8081 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
8082 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb()
8083 * @gfp: allocation flags
8084 *
8085 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
8086 * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always
8087 * consumes it.
8088 */
cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff * skb,gfp_t gfp)8089 static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
8090 {
8091 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
8092 }
8093
8094 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd) .testmode_cmd = (cmd),
8095 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd) .testmode_dump = (cmd),
8096 #else
8097 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)
8098 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)
8099 #endif
8100
8101 /**
8102 * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params
8103 * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL)
8104 * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets
8105 * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in
8106 * @erp_next_seq_num is valid.
8107 * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in
8108 * FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the
8109 * status for a FILS connection.
8110 * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL).
8111 * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets
8112 * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID
8113 * used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL).
8114 */
8115 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params {
8116 const u8 *kek;
8117 size_t kek_len;
8118 bool update_erp_next_seq_num;
8119 u16 erp_next_seq_num;
8120 const u8 *pmk;
8121 size_t pmk_len;
8122 const u8 *pmkid;
8123 };
8124
8125 /**
8126 * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params
8127 * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
8128 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
8129 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
8130 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
8131 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
8132 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
8133 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
8134 * case.
8135 * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL)
8136 * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length
8137 * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8138 * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length
8139 * @fils: FILS connection response parameters.
8140 * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
8141 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
8142 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
8143 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
8144 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
8145 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
8146 * @valid_links: For MLO connection, BIT mask of the valid link ids. Otherwise
8147 * zero.
8148 * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the AP. Otherwise %NULL.
8149 * @links : For MLO connection, contains link info for the valid links indicated
8150 * using @valid_links. For non-MLO connection, links[0] contains the
8151 * connected AP info.
8152 * @links.addr: For MLO connection, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise
8153 * %NULL.
8154 * @links.bssid: For MLO connection, MAC address of the AP link. For non-MLO
8155 * connection, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL).
8156 * @links.bss: For MLO connection, entry of bss to which STA link is connected.
8157 * For non-MLO connection, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to which STA
8158 * is connected. It can be obtained through cfg80211_get_bss() (may be
8159 * %NULL). It is recommended to store the bss from the connect_request and
8160 * hold a reference to it and return through this param to avoid a warning
8161 * if the bss is expired during the connection, esp. for those drivers
8162 * implementing connect op. Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs
8163 * to be specified.
8164 * @links.status: per-link status code, to report a status code that's not
8165 * %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for a given link, it must also be in the
8166 * @valid_links bitmap and may have a BSS pointer (which is then released)
8167 */
8168 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params {
8169 int status;
8170 const u8 *req_ie;
8171 size_t req_ie_len;
8172 const u8 *resp_ie;
8173 size_t resp_ie_len;
8174 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
8175 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason;
8176
8177 const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
8178 u16 valid_links;
8179 struct {
8180 const u8 *addr;
8181 const u8 *bssid;
8182 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
8183 u16 status;
8184 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
8185 };
8186
8187 /**
8188 * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result
8189 *
8190 * @dev: network device
8191 * @params: connection response parameters
8192 * @gfp: allocation flags
8193 *
8194 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
8195 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
8196 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response
8197 * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(),
8198 * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(),
8199 * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8200 */
8201 void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev,
8202 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params,
8203 gfp_t gfp);
8204
8205 /**
8206 * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result
8207 *
8208 * @dev: network device
8209 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
8210 * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through
8211 * cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the
8212 * bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return
8213 * through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the
8214 * connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op.
8215 * Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified.
8216 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8217 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8218 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8219 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
8220 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
8221 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
8222 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
8223 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
8224 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
8225 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
8226 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
8227 * case.
8228 * @gfp: allocation flags
8229 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
8230 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
8231 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
8232 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
8233 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
8234 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
8235 *
8236 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
8237 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
8238 * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss
8239 * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among
8240 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
8241 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8242 */
8243 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,struct cfg80211_bss * bss,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,const u8 * resp_ie,size_t resp_ie_len,int status,gfp_t gfp,enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)8244 cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8245 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie,
8246 size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie,
8247 size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp,
8248 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
8249 {
8250 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params;
8251
8252 memset(¶ms, 0, sizeof(params));
8253 params.status = status;
8254 params.links[0].bssid = bssid;
8255 params.links[0].bss = bss;
8256 params.req_ie = req_ie;
8257 params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len;
8258 params.resp_ie = resp_ie;
8259 params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len;
8260 params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason;
8261
8262 cfg80211_connect_done(dev, ¶ms, gfp);
8263 }
8264
8265 /**
8266 * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result
8267 *
8268 * @dev: network device
8269 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
8270 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8271 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8272 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8273 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
8274 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
8275 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
8276 * the real status code for failures.
8277 * @gfp: allocation flags
8278 *
8279 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
8280 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
8281 * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only
8282 * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
8283 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8284 */
8285 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,const u8 * resp_ie,size_t resp_ie_len,u16 status,gfp_t gfp)8286 cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8287 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len,
8288 const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len,
8289 u16 status, gfp_t gfp)
8290 {
8291 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie,
8292 resp_ie_len, status, gfp,
8293 NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED);
8294 }
8295
8296 /**
8297 * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout
8298 *
8299 * @dev: network device
8300 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
8301 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8302 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8303 * @gfp: allocation flags
8304 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout.
8305 *
8306 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed
8307 * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was
8308 * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send
8309 * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while
8310 * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among
8311 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
8312 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8313 */
8314 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,gfp_t gfp,enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)8315 cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8316 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp,
8317 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
8318 {
8319 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1,
8320 gfp, timeout_reason);
8321 }
8322
8323 /**
8324 * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information
8325 *
8326 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8327 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8328 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8329 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
8330 * @fils: FILS related roaming information.
8331 * @valid_links: For MLO roaming, BIT mask of the new valid links is set.
8332 * Otherwise zero.
8333 * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO roaming, MLD address of the new AP. Otherwise %NULL.
8334 * @links : For MLO roaming, contains new link info for the valid links set in
8335 * @valid_links. For non-MLO roaming, links[0] contains the new AP info.
8336 * @links.addr: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise %NULL.
8337 * @links.bssid: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the new AP link. For non-MLO
8338 * roaming, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the new AP. May be
8339 * %NULL if %links.bss is set.
8340 * @links.channel: the channel of the new AP.
8341 * @links.bss: For MLO roaming, entry of new bss to which STA link got
8342 * roamed. For non-MLO roaming, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to
8343 * which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %links.bssid is set)
8344 */
8345 struct cfg80211_roam_info {
8346 const u8 *req_ie;
8347 size_t req_ie_len;
8348 const u8 *resp_ie;
8349 size_t resp_ie_len;
8350 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
8351
8352 const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
8353 u16 valid_links;
8354 struct {
8355 const u8 *addr;
8356 const u8 *bssid;
8357 struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
8358 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
8359 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
8360 };
8361
8362 /**
8363 * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming
8364 *
8365 * @dev: network device
8366 * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info.
8367 * @gfp: allocation flags
8368 *
8369 * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the
8370 * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry.
8371 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP
8372 * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in
8373 * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where
8374 * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the
8375 * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling
8376 * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released
8377 * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be
8378 * released while disconnecting from the current bss.
8379 */
8380 void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info,
8381 gfp_t gfp);
8382
8383 /**
8384 * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association
8385 *
8386 * @dev: network device
8387 * @peer_addr: BSSID of the AP/P2P GO in case of STA/GC or STA/GC MAC address
8388 * in case of AP/P2P GO
8389 * @td_bitmap: transition disable policy
8390 * @td_bitmap_len: Length of transition disable policy
8391 * @gfp: allocation flags
8392 *
8393 * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake
8394 * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e.,
8395 * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function
8396 * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(),
8397 * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to
8398 * indicate the 802.11 association.
8399 * This function can also be called by AP/P2P GO driver that supports
8400 * authentication offload. In this case the peer_mac passed is that of
8401 * associated STA/GC.
8402 */
8403 void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer_addr,
8404 const u8* td_bitmap, u8 td_bitmap_len, gfp_t gfp);
8405
8406 /**
8407 * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped
8408 *
8409 * @dev: network device
8410 * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL)
8411 * @ie_len: length of IEs
8412 * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown
8413 * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally
8414 * @gfp: allocation flags
8415 *
8416 * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state
8417 * and not try to connect to any AP any more.
8418 */
8419 void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason,
8420 const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len,
8421 bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp);
8422
8423 /**
8424 * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start
8425 * @wdev: wireless device
8426 * @cookie: the request cookie
8427 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
8428 * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the
8429 * channel
8430 * @gfp: allocation flags
8431 */
8432 void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8433 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
8434 unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp);
8435
8436 /**
8437 * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
8438 * @wdev: wireless device
8439 * @cookie: the request cookie
8440 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
8441 * @gfp: allocation flags
8442 */
8443 void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8444 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
8445 gfp_t gfp);
8446
8447 /**
8448 * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired
8449 * @wdev: wireless device
8450 * @cookie: the requested cookie
8451 * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request)
8452 * @gfp: allocation flags
8453 */
8454 void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8455 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp);
8456
8457 /**
8458 * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics.
8459 *
8460 * @sinfo: the station information
8461 * @gfp: allocation flags
8462 *
8463 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
8464 */
8465 int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8466
8467 /**
8468 * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info
8469 * @sinfo: the station information
8470 *
8471 * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station
8472 * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on
8473 * the stack.)
8474 */
cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info * sinfo)8475 static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo)
8476 {
8477 kfree(sinfo->pertid);
8478 }
8479
8480 /**
8481 * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station
8482 *
8483 * @dev: the netdev
8484 * @mac_addr: the station's address
8485 * @sinfo: the station information
8486 * @gfp: allocation flags
8487 */
8488 void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8489 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8490
8491 /**
8492 * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station
8493 * @dev: the netdev
8494 * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used.
8495 * @sinfo: the station information/statistics
8496 * @gfp: allocation flags
8497 */
8498 void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8499 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8500
8501 /**
8502 * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station
8503 *
8504 * @dev: the netdev
8505 * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used.
8506 * @gfp: allocation flags
8507 */
cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * mac_addr,gfp_t gfp)8508 static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev,
8509 const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp)
8510 {
8511 cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp);
8512 }
8513
8514 /**
8515 * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification
8516 *
8517 * @dev: the netdev
8518 * @mac_addr: the station's address
8519 * @reason: the reason for connection failure
8520 * @gfp: allocation flags
8521 *
8522 * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station
8523 * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection
8524 * for some reasons, this function is called.
8525 *
8526 * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from
8527 * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum
8528 */
8529 void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8530 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason,
8531 gfp_t gfp);
8532
8533 /**
8534 * struct cfg80211_rx_info - received management frame info
8535 *
8536 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in kHz
8537 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8538 * @have_link_id: indicates the frame was received on a link of
8539 * an MLD, i.e. the @link_id field is valid
8540 * @link_id: the ID of the link the frame was received on
8541 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8542 * @len: length of the frame data
8543 * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8544 * @rx_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of frame RX in nanoseconds
8545 * @ack_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of ack TX in nanoseconds
8546 */
8547 struct cfg80211_rx_info {
8548 int freq;
8549 int sig_dbm;
8550 bool have_link_id;
8551 u8 link_id;
8552 const u8 *buf;
8553 size_t len;
8554 u32 flags;
8555 u64 rx_tstamp;
8556 u64 ack_tstamp;
8557 };
8558
8559 /**
8560 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext - management frame notification with extended info
8561 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8562 * @info: RX info as defined in struct cfg80211_rx_info
8563 *
8564 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8565 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8566 *
8567 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8568 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8569 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8570 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8571 */
8572 bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8573 struct cfg80211_rx_info *info);
8574
8575 /**
8576 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
8577 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8578 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz
8579 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8580 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8581 * @len: length of the frame data
8582 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8583 *
8584 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8585 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8586 *
8587 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8588 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8589 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8590 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8591 */
cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev * wdev,int freq,int sig_dbm,const u8 * buf,size_t len,u32 flags)8592 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
8593 int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
8594 u32 flags)
8595 {
8596 struct cfg80211_rx_info info = {
8597 .freq = freq,
8598 .sig_dbm = sig_dbm,
8599 .buf = buf,
8600 .len = len,
8601 .flags = flags
8602 };
8603
8604 return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info);
8605 }
8606
8607 /**
8608 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
8609 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8610 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz
8611 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8612 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8613 * @len: length of the frame data
8614 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8615 *
8616 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8617 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8618 *
8619 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8620 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8621 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8622 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8623 */
cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev * wdev,int freq,int sig_dbm,const u8 * buf,size_t len,u32 flags)8624 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
8625 int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
8626 u32 flags)
8627 {
8628 struct cfg80211_rx_info info = {
8629 .freq = MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
8630 .sig_dbm = sig_dbm,
8631 .buf = buf,
8632 .len = len,
8633 .flags = flags
8634 };
8635
8636 return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info);
8637 }
8638
8639 /**
8640 * struct cfg80211_tx_status - TX status for management frame information
8641 *
8642 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
8643 * @tx_tstamp: hardware TX timestamp in nanoseconds
8644 * @ack_tstamp: hardware ack RX timestamp in nanoseconds
8645 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8646 * @len: length of the frame data
8647 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8648 */
8649 struct cfg80211_tx_status {
8650 u64 cookie;
8651 u64 tx_tstamp;
8652 u64 ack_tstamp;
8653 const u8 *buf;
8654 size_t len;
8655 bool ack;
8656 };
8657
8658 /**
8659 * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext - TX status notification with extended info
8660 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8661 * @status: TX status data
8662 * @gfp: context flags
8663 *
8664 * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
8665 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
8666 * transmission attempt with extended info.
8667 */
8668 void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8669 struct cfg80211_tx_status *status, gfp_t gfp);
8670
8671 /**
8672 * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame
8673 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8674 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
8675 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8676 * @len: length of the frame data
8677 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8678 * @gfp: context flags
8679 *
8680 * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
8681 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
8682 * transmission attempt.
8683 */
cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev * wdev,u64 cookie,const u8 * buf,size_t len,bool ack,gfp_t gfp)8684 static inline void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8685 u64 cookie, const u8 *buf,
8686 size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp)
8687 {
8688 struct cfg80211_tx_status status = {
8689 .cookie = cookie,
8690 .buf = buf,
8691 .len = len,
8692 .ack = ack
8693 };
8694
8695 cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(wdev, &status, gfp);
8696 }
8697
8698 /**
8699 * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control
8700 * port frames
8701 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8702 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port()
8703 * @buf: Data frame (header + body)
8704 * @len: length of the frame data
8705 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8706 * @gfp: context flags
8707 *
8708 * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be
8709 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of
8710 * the transmission attempt.
8711 */
8712 void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8713 const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack,
8714 gfp_t gfp);
8715
8716 /**
8717 * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame
8718 * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8719 * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame. It is assumed that the skbuf
8720 * is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header). The skb can be non-linear.
8721 * This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is
8722 * responsible for any cleanup. The caller must also ensure that
8723 * skb->protocol is set appropriately.
8724 * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted
8725 * @link_id: the link the frame was received on, -1 if not applicable or unknown
8726 *
8727 * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port
8728 * frame. It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive
8729 * control port frames over nl80211.
8730 *
8731 * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all
8732 * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame).
8733 *
8734 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace
8735 */
8736 bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev, struct sk_buff *skb,
8737 bool unencrypted, int link_id);
8738
8739 /**
8740 * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event
8741 * @dev: network device
8742 * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event
8743 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
8744 * @gfp: context flags
8745 *
8746 * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring
8747 * rssi threshold reached event occurs.
8748 */
8749 void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8750 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
8751 s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp);
8752
8753 /**
8754 * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer
8755 * @dev: network device
8756 * @peer: peer's MAC address
8757 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold
8758 * but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent
8759 * threshold (to account for temporary interference)
8760 * @gfp: context flags
8761 */
8762 void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8763 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp);
8764
8765 /**
8766 * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event
8767 * @dev: network device
8768 * @peer: peer's MAC address
8769 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost
8770 * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission
8771 * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached.
8772 * @gfp: context flags
8773 *
8774 * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a
8775 * given interval is exceeded.
8776 */
8777 void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
8778 u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp);
8779
8780 /**
8781 * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event
8782 * @dev: network device
8783 * @gfp: context flags
8784 *
8785 * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP.
8786 */
8787 void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp);
8788
8789 /**
8790 * __cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event
8791 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8792 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
8793 * @offchan: the radar has been detected on the offchannel chain
8794 * @gfp: context flags
8795 *
8796 * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl.
8797 */
8798 void __cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8799 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8800 bool offchan, gfp_t gfp);
8801
8802 static inline void
cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef,gfp_t gfp)8803 cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8804 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8805 gfp_t gfp)
8806 {
8807 __cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, false, gfp);
8808 }
8809
8810 static inline void
cfg80211_background_radar_event(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef,gfp_t gfp)8811 cfg80211_background_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8812 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8813 gfp_t gfp)
8814 {
8815 __cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, true, gfp);
8816 }
8817
8818 /**
8819 * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event
8820 * @dev: network device
8821 * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified
8822 * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value
8823 * @gfp: context flags
8824 *
8825 * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action
8826 * frame.
8827 */
8828 void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac,
8829 struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode,
8830 gfp_t gfp);
8831
8832 /**
8833 * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event
8834 * @netdev: network device
8835 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
8836 * @event: type of event
8837 * @gfp: context flags
8838 * @link_id: valid link_id for MLO operation or 0 otherwise.
8839 *
8840 * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished
8841 * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process,
8842 * also by full-MAC drivers.
8843 */
8844 void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev,
8845 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8846 enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp,
8847 unsigned int link_id);
8848
8849 /**
8850 * cfg80211_background_cac_abort - Channel Availability Check offchan abort event
8851 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8852 *
8853 * This function is called by the driver when a Channel Availability Check
8854 * (CAC) is aborted by a offchannel dedicated chain.
8855 */
8856 void cfg80211_background_cac_abort(struct wiphy *wiphy);
8857
8858 /**
8859 * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying
8860 * @dev: network device
8861 * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races)
8862 * @replay_ctr: new replay counter
8863 * @gfp: allocation flags
8864 */
8865 void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8866 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
8867
8868 /**
8869 * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate
8870 * @dev: network device
8871 * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority)
8872 * @bssid: BSSID of AP
8873 * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication
8874 * @gfp: allocation flags
8875 */
8876 void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index,
8877 const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp);
8878
8879 /**
8880 * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame
8881 * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8882 * @addr: the transmitter address
8883 * @gfp: context flags
8884 *
8885 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
8886 * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the
8887 * sender.
8888 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
8889 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
8890 */
8891 bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev,
8892 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
8893
8894 /**
8895 * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame
8896 * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8897 * @addr: the transmitter address
8898 * @gfp: context flags
8899 *
8900 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
8901 * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected.
8902 * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each
8903 * station to avoid event flooding.
8904 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
8905 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
8906 */
8907 bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev,
8908 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
8909
8910 /**
8911 * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status
8912 * @dev: the device the probe was sent on
8913 * @addr: the address of the peer
8914 * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously
8915 * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not
8916 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame.
8917 * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not.
8918 * @gfp: allocation flags
8919 */
8920 void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
8921 u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal,
8922 bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp);
8923
8924 /**
8925 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs
8926 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
8927 * @frame: the frame
8928 * @len: length of the frame
8929 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz
8930 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8931 *
8932 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
8933 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
8934 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
8935 */
8936 void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame,
8937 size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm);
8938
8939 /**
8940 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs
8941 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
8942 * @frame: the frame
8943 * @len: length of the frame
8944 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on
8945 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8946 *
8947 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
8948 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
8949 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
8950 */
cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy * wiphy,const u8 * frame,size_t len,int freq,int sig_dbm)8951 static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8952 const u8 *frame, size_t len,
8953 int freq, int sig_dbm)
8954 {
8955 cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
8956 sig_dbm);
8957 }
8958
8959 /**
8960 * struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config - beacon check configuration
8961 * @iftype: the interface type to check for
8962 * @relax: allow IR-relaxation conditions to apply (e.g. another
8963 * interface connected already on the same channel)
8964 * NOTE: If this is set, wiphy mutex must be held.
8965 * @reg_power: &enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power value indicating the
8966 * advertised/used 6 GHz regulatory power setting
8967 */
8968 struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config {
8969 enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
8970 enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power reg_power;
8971 bool relax;
8972 };
8973
8974 /**
8975 * cfg80211_reg_check_beaconing - check if beaconing is allowed
8976 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8977 * @chandef: the channel definition
8978 * @cfg: additional parameters for the checking
8979 *
8980 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
8981 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.)
8982 */
8983 bool cfg80211_reg_check_beaconing(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8984 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8985 struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config *cfg);
8986
8987 /**
8988 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed
8989 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8990 * @chandef: the channel definition
8991 * @iftype: interface type
8992 *
8993 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
8994 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.)
8995 */
8996 static inline bool
cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)8997 cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8998 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8999 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
9000 {
9001 struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config config = {
9002 .iftype = iftype,
9003 };
9004
9005 return cfg80211_reg_check_beaconing(wiphy, chandef, &config);
9006 }
9007
9008 /**
9009 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation
9010 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9011 * @chandef: the channel definition
9012 * @iftype: interface type
9013 *
9014 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
9015 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version
9016 * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under
9017 * more permissive conditions.
9018 *
9019 * Context: Requires the wiphy mutex to be held.
9020 */
9021 static inline bool
cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)9022 cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9023 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
9024 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
9025 {
9026 struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config config = {
9027 .iftype = iftype,
9028 .relax = true,
9029 };
9030
9031 return cfg80211_reg_check_beaconing(wiphy, chandef, &config);
9032 }
9033
9034 /**
9035 * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace
9036 * @dev: the device which switched channels
9037 * @chandef: the new channel definition
9038 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO
9039 *
9040 * Caller must hold wiphy mutex, therefore must only be called from sleepable
9041 * driver context!
9042 */
9043 void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9044 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
9045 unsigned int link_id);
9046
9047 /**
9048 * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start
9049 * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started
9050 * @chandef: the future channel definition
9051 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO
9052 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens
9053 * @quiet: whether or not immediate quiet was requested by the AP
9054 *
9055 * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just
9056 * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting
9057 * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary.
9058 */
9059 void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9060 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
9061 unsigned int link_id, u8 count,
9062 bool quiet);
9063
9064 /**
9065 * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band
9066 *
9067 * @operating_class: the operating class to convert
9068 * @band: band pointer to fill
9069 *
9070 * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
9071 */
9072 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class,
9073 enum nl80211_band *band);
9074
9075 /**
9076 * ieee80211_operating_class_to_chandef - convert operating class to chandef
9077 *
9078 * @operating_class: the operating class to convert
9079 * @chan: the ieee80211_channel to convert
9080 * @chandef: a pointer to the resulting chandef
9081 *
9082 * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
9083 */
9084 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_chandef(u8 operating_class,
9085 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
9086 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
9087
9088 /**
9089 * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class
9090 *
9091 * @chandef: the chandef to convert
9092 * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class
9093 *
9094 * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
9095 */
9096 bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
9097 u8 *op_class);
9098
9099 /**
9100 * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz
9101 *
9102 * @chandef: the chandef to convert
9103 *
9104 * Return: the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz.
9105 */
9106 static inline u32
ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)9107 ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
9108 {
9109 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset;
9110 }
9111
9112 /**
9113 * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation
9114 * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested
9115 * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device
9116 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or
9117 * NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN)
9118 * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request
9119 * @gfp: allocation flags
9120 *
9121 * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that
9122 * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP
9123 * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use
9124 * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g.,
9125 * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer).
9126 */
9127 void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
9128 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
9129 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
9130
9131 /**
9132 * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units)
9133 * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from
9134 *
9135 * Return: calculated bitrate
9136 */
9137 u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate);
9138
9139 /**
9140 * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev
9141 * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove
9142 *
9143 * This function removes the device so it can no longer be used. It is necessary
9144 * to call this function even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the device
9145 * by calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also be called
9146 * when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g. when the hardware device
9147 * is unbound from the driver.
9148 *
9149 * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
9150 */
9151 void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
9152
9153 /**
9154 * cfg80211_register_netdevice - register the given netdev
9155 * @dev: the netdev to register
9156 *
9157 * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
9158 * than register_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL is
9159 * held. Otherwise, both register_netdevice() and register_netdev() are usable
9160 * instead as well.
9161 *
9162 * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
9163 *
9164 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9165 */
9166 int cfg80211_register_netdevice(struct net_device *dev);
9167
9168 /**
9169 * cfg80211_unregister_netdevice - unregister the given netdev
9170 * @dev: the netdev to register
9171 *
9172 * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
9173 * than unregister_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL
9174 * is held. Otherwise, both unregister_netdevice() and unregister_netdev() are
9175 * usable instead as well.
9176 *
9177 * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
9178 */
cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device * dev)9179 static inline void cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device *dev)
9180 {
9181 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
9182 cfg80211_unregister_wdev(dev->ieee80211_ptr);
9183 #endif
9184 }
9185
9186 /**
9187 * struct cfg80211_ft_event_params - FT Information Elements
9188 * @ies: FT IEs
9189 * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes
9190 * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address
9191 * @ric_ies: RIC IE
9192 * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes
9193 */
9194 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params {
9195 const u8 *ies;
9196 size_t ies_len;
9197 const u8 *target_ap;
9198 const u8 *ric_ies;
9199 size_t ric_ies_len;
9200 };
9201
9202 /**
9203 * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE
9204 * @netdev: network device
9205 * @ft_event: IE information
9206 */
9207 void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev,
9208 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event);
9209
9210 /**
9211 * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer
9212 * @ies: the input IE buffer
9213 * @len: the input length
9214 * @attr: the attribute ID to find
9215 * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g.
9216 * if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size
9217 * @bufsize: size of the output buffer
9218 *
9219 * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and
9220 * copies its contents to the given buffer.
9221 *
9222 * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is
9223 * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the
9224 * length of the found attribute (which can be zero).
9225 */
9226 int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
9227 enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr,
9228 u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize);
9229
9230 /**
9231 * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC)
9232 * @ies: the IE buffer
9233 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
9234 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
9235 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
9236 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
9237 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
9238 * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element
9239 * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array
9240 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
9241 *
9242 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
9243 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
9244 * split.
9245 *
9246 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
9247 * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
9248 *
9249 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
9250 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
9251 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
9252 *
9253 * Return: The offset where the next part of the buffer starts, which
9254 * may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) of the buffer should be
9255 * used.
9256 */
9257 size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
9258 const u8 *ids, int n_ids,
9259 const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric,
9260 size_t offset);
9261
9262 /**
9263 * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering
9264 * @ies: the IE buffer
9265 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
9266 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
9267 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
9268 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
9269 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
9270 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
9271 *
9272 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
9273 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
9274 * split.
9275 *
9276 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
9277 * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
9278 *
9279 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
9280 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
9281 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
9282 *
9283 * Return: The offset where the next part of the buffer starts, which
9284 * may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) of the buffer should be
9285 * used.
9286 */
ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 * ies,size_t ielen,const u8 * ids,int n_ids,size_t offset)9287 static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
9288 const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset)
9289 {
9290 return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset);
9291 }
9292
9293 /**
9294 * ieee80211_fragment_element - fragment the last element in skb
9295 * @skb: The skbuf that the element was added to
9296 * @len_pos: Pointer to length of the element to fragment
9297 * @frag_id: The element ID to use for fragments
9298 *
9299 * This function fragments all data after @len_pos, adding fragmentation
9300 * elements with the given ID as appropriate. The SKB will grow in size
9301 * accordingly.
9302 */
9303 void ieee80211_fragment_element(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *len_pos, u8 frag_id);
9304
9305 /**
9306 * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN
9307 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup
9308 * @wakeup: the wakeup report
9309 * @gfp: allocation flags
9310 *
9311 * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it
9312 * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may
9313 * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something
9314 * else caused the wakeup.
9315 */
9316 void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9317 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
9318 gfp_t gfp);
9319
9320 /**
9321 * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver.
9322 *
9323 * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped.
9324 * @gfp: allocation flags
9325 *
9326 * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted
9327 * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given
9328 * by .crit_proto_start() has expired.
9329 */
9330 void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp);
9331
9332 /**
9333 * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has
9334 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9335 *
9336 * Return: the number of channels supported by the device.
9337 */
9338 unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9339
9340 /**
9341 * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations
9342 *
9343 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9344 * @params: the interface combinations parameter
9345 *
9346 * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a
9347 * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to
9348 * the interface combinations.
9349 *
9350 * Return: 0 if combinations are allowed. Non-zero on error.
9351 */
9352 int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9353 struct iface_combination_params *params);
9354
9355 /**
9356 * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations
9357 *
9358 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9359 * @params: the interface combinations parameter
9360 * @iter: function to call for each matching combination
9361 * @data: pointer to pass to iter function
9362 *
9363 * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible
9364 * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching
9365 * purposes.
9366 *
9367 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9368 */
9369 int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9370 struct iface_combination_params *params,
9371 void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c,
9372 void *data),
9373 void *data);
9374
9375 /**
9376 * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection
9377 *
9378 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9379 * @wdev: wireless device
9380 * @gfp: context flags
9381 *
9382 * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA
9383 * disconnected.
9384 *
9385 * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous.
9386 */
9387 void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9388 gfp_t gfp);
9389
9390 /**
9391 * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy
9392 * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down
9393 *
9394 * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by
9395 * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed).
9396 * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors
9397 * that really can't be recovered in any other way.
9398 *
9399 * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into
9400 * the driver while the function is running.
9401 */
9402 void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9403
9404 /**
9405 * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag
9406 *
9407 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
9408 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
9409 *
9410 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
9411 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
9412 */
wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy * wiphy,enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)9413 static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9414 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
9415 {
9416 u8 *ft_byte;
9417
9418 ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
9419 *ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8);
9420 }
9421
9422 /**
9423 * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag
9424 *
9425 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
9426 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
9427 *
9428 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
9429 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
9430 *
9431 * Return: %true if extended feature flag is set, %false otherwise
9432 */
9433 static inline bool
wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy * wiphy,enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)9434 wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9435 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
9436 {
9437 u8 ft_byte;
9438
9439 ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
9440 return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0;
9441 }
9442
9443 /**
9444 * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function
9445 * @f: NAN function that should be freed
9446 *
9447 * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members.
9448 */
9449 void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f);
9450
9451 /**
9452 * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters
9453 * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is
9454 * %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber.
9455 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery
9456 * result.
9457 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up.
9458 * @inst_id: the local instance id
9459 * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function
9460 * @addr: the MAC address of the peer
9461 * @info_len: the length of the &info
9462 * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any)
9463 * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function
9464 */
9465 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params {
9466 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
9467 u8 inst_id;
9468 u8 peer_inst_id;
9469 const u8 *addr;
9470 u8 info_len;
9471 const u8 *info;
9472 u64 cookie;
9473 };
9474
9475 /**
9476 * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function.
9477 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
9478 * @match: match notification parameters
9479 * @gfp: allocation flags
9480 *
9481 * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This
9482 * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that
9483 * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received.
9484 */
9485 void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9486 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp);
9487
9488 /**
9489 * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
9490 *
9491 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
9492 * @inst_id: the local instance id
9493 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
9494 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier
9495 * @gfp: allocation flags
9496 *
9497 * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated.
9498 */
9499 void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9500 u8 inst_id,
9501 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
9502 u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp);
9503
9504 /* ethtool helper */
9505 void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info);
9506
9507 /**
9508 * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication
9509 * @netdev: network device
9510 * @params: External authentication parameters
9511 * @gfp: allocation flags
9512 * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error
9513 */
9514 int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev,
9515 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params,
9516 gfp_t gfp);
9517
9518 /**
9519 * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data
9520 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
9521 * @req: the original measurement request
9522 * @result: the result data
9523 * @gfp: allocation flags
9524 */
9525 void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9526 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
9527 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result,
9528 gfp_t gfp);
9529
9530 /**
9531 * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed
9532 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
9533 * @req: the original measurement request
9534 * @gfp: allocation flags
9535 *
9536 * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this
9537 * the request pointer will no longer be valid.
9538 */
9539 void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9540 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
9541 gfp_t gfp);
9542
9543 /**
9544 * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed
9545 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9546 * @iftype: interface type
9547 * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1'
9548 * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces
9549 *
9550 * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API
9551 * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when
9552 * check_swif is '1'.
9553 *
9554 * Return: %true if allowed, %false otherwise
9555 */
9556 bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
9557 bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif);
9558
9559
9560 /**
9561 * cfg80211_assoc_comeback - notification of association that was
9562 * temporarily rejected with a comeback
9563 * @netdev: network device
9564 * @ap_addr: AP (MLD) address that rejected the association
9565 * @timeout: timeout interval value TUs.
9566 *
9567 * this function may sleep. the caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
9568 */
9569 void cfg80211_assoc_comeback(struct net_device *netdev,
9570 const u8 *ap_addr, u32 timeout);
9571
9572 /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */
9573
9574 /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */
9575
9576 #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...) \
9577 dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9578 #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...) \
9579 dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9580 #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...) \
9581 dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9582 #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...) \
9583 dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9584 #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...) \
9585 dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9586 #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...) \
9587 dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9588 #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...) \
9589 dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9590 #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...) \
9591 dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9592 #define wiphy_info_once(wiphy, format, args...) \
9593 dev_info_once(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9594
9595 #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \
9596 dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9597 #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \
9598 dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9599
9600 #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...) \
9601 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args)
9602
9603 #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...) \
9604 dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9605
9606 #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG)
9607 #define wiphy_vdbg wiphy_dbg
9608 #else
9609 #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...) \
9610 ({ \
9611 if (0) \
9612 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args); \
9613 0; \
9614 })
9615 #endif
9616
9617 /*
9618 * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference
9619 * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the
9620 * file/line information and a backtrace.
9621 */
9622 #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...) \
9623 WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args);
9624
9625 /**
9626 * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space
9627 * @netdev: network device
9628 * @owe_info: peer's owe info
9629 * @gfp: allocation flags
9630 */
9631 void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev,
9632 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info,
9633 gfp_t gfp);
9634
9635 /**
9636 * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries
9637 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9638 */
9639 void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9640
9641 /**
9642 * cfg80211_bss_color_notify - notify about bss color event
9643 * @dev: network device
9644 * @cmd: the actual event we want to notify
9645 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens
9646 * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of
9647 * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9648 *
9649 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9650 */
9651 int cfg80211_bss_color_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9652 enum nl80211_commands cmd, u8 count,
9653 u64 color_bitmap, u8 link_id);
9654
9655 /**
9656 * cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify about bss color collision
9657 * @dev: network device
9658 * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of
9659 * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9660 *
9661 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9662 */
cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device * dev,u64 color_bitmap,u8 link_id)9663 static inline int cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9664 u64 color_bitmap,
9665 u8 link_id)
9666 {
9667 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION,
9668 0, color_bitmap, link_id);
9669 }
9670
9671 /**
9672 * cfg80211_color_change_started_notify - notify color change start
9673 * @dev: the device on which the color is switched
9674 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens
9675 * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9676 *
9677 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has started.
9678 *
9679 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9680 */
cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device * dev,u8 count,u8 link_id)9681 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9682 u8 count, u8 link_id)
9683 {
9684 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED,
9685 count, 0, link_id);
9686 }
9687
9688 /**
9689 * cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify - notify color change abort
9690 * @dev: the device on which the color is switched
9691 * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9692 *
9693 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has aborted.
9694 *
9695 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9696 */
cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device * dev,u8 link_id)9697 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9698 u8 link_id)
9699 {
9700 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED,
9701 0, 0, link_id);
9702 }
9703
9704 /**
9705 * cfg80211_color_change_notify - notify color change completion
9706 * @dev: the device on which the color was switched
9707 * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9708 *
9709 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has completed.
9710 *
9711 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9712 */
cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device * dev,u8 link_id)9713 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9714 u8 link_id)
9715 {
9716 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev,
9717 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED,
9718 0, 0, link_id);
9719 }
9720
9721 /**
9722 * cfg80211_links_removed - Notify about removed STA MLD setup links.
9723 * @dev: network device.
9724 * @link_mask: BIT mask of removed STA MLD setup link IDs.
9725 *
9726 * Inform cfg80211 and the userspace about removed STA MLD setup links due to
9727 * AP MLD removing the corresponding affiliated APs with Multi-Link
9728 * reconfiguration. Note that it's not valid to remove all links, in this
9729 * case disconnect instead.
9730 * Also note that the wdev mutex must be held.
9731 */
9732 void cfg80211_links_removed(struct net_device *dev, u16 link_mask);
9733
9734 /**
9735 * struct cfg80211_mlo_reconf_done_data - MLO reconfiguration data
9736 * @buf: MLO Reconfiguration Response frame (header + body)
9737 * @len: length of the frame data
9738 * @added_links: BIT mask of links successfully added to the association
9739 * @links: per-link information indexed by link ID
9740 * @links.bss: the BSS that MLO reconfiguration was requested for, ownership of
9741 * the pointer moves to cfg80211 in the call to
9742 * cfg80211_mlo_reconf_add_done().
9743 *
9744 * The BSS pointer must be set for each link for which 'add' operation was
9745 * requested in the assoc_ml_reconf callback.
9746 */
9747 struct cfg80211_mlo_reconf_done_data {
9748 const u8 *buf;
9749 size_t len;
9750 u16 added_links;
9751 struct {
9752 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
9753 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
9754 };
9755
9756 /**
9757 * cfg80211_mlo_reconf_add_done - Notify about MLO reconfiguration result
9758 * @dev: network device.
9759 * @data: MLO reconfiguration done data, &struct cfg80211_mlo_reconf_done_data
9760 *
9761 * Inform cfg80211 and the userspace that processing of ML reconfiguration
9762 * request to add links to the association is done.
9763 */
9764 void cfg80211_mlo_reconf_add_done(struct net_device *dev,
9765 struct cfg80211_mlo_reconf_done_data *data);
9766
9767 /**
9768 * cfg80211_schedule_channels_check - schedule regulatory check if needed
9769 * @wdev: the wireless device to check
9770 *
9771 * In case the device supports NO_IR or DFS relaxations, schedule regulatory
9772 * channels check, as previous concurrent operation conditions may not
9773 * hold anymore.
9774 */
9775 void cfg80211_schedule_channels_check(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
9776
9777 /**
9778 * cfg80211_epcs_changed - Notify about a change in EPCS state
9779 * @netdev: the wireless device whose EPCS state changed
9780 * @enabled: set to true if EPCS was enabled, otherwise set to false.
9781 */
9782 void cfg80211_epcs_changed(struct net_device *netdev, bool enabled);
9783
9784 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_DEBUGFS
9785 /**
9786 * wiphy_locked_debugfs_read - do a locked read in debugfs
9787 * @wiphy: the wiphy to use
9788 * @file: the file being read
9789 * @buf: the buffer to fill and then read from
9790 * @bufsize: size of the buffer
9791 * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy to
9792 * @count: read count
9793 * @ppos: read position
9794 * @handler: the read handler to call (under wiphy lock)
9795 * @data: additional data to pass to the read handler
9796 *
9797 * Return: the number of characters read, or a negative errno
9798 */
9799 ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_read(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file,
9800 char *buf, size_t bufsize,
9801 char __user *userbuf, size_t count,
9802 loff_t *ppos,
9803 ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9804 struct file *file,
9805 char *buf,
9806 size_t bufsize,
9807 void *data),
9808 void *data);
9809
9810 /**
9811 * wiphy_locked_debugfs_write - do a locked write in debugfs
9812 * @wiphy: the wiphy to use
9813 * @file: the file being written to
9814 * @buf: the buffer to copy the user data to
9815 * @bufsize: size of the buffer
9816 * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy from
9817 * @count: read count
9818 * @handler: the write handler to call (under wiphy lock)
9819 * @data: additional data to pass to the write handler
9820 *
9821 * Return: the number of characters written, or a negative errno
9822 */
9823 ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_write(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file,
9824 char *buf, size_t bufsize,
9825 const char __user *userbuf, size_t count,
9826 ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9827 struct file *file,
9828 char *buf,
9829 size_t count,
9830 void *data),
9831 void *data);
9832 #endif
9833
9834 #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */
9835